blob: 05f76521f2939de96dc7816692bae94a3db01f70 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauad90f0d2015-06-17 15:53:25 +02007 2015/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200615.3. Server DNS resolution
625.3.1. Global overview
635.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064
656. HTTP header manipulation
66
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
858. Logging
868.1. Log levels
878.2. Log formats
888.2.1. Default log format
898.2.2. TCP log format
908.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100918.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100928.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200938.3. Advanced logging options
948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
988.4. Timing events
998.5. Session state at disconnection
1008.6. Non-printable characters
1018.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1038.9. Examples of logs
104
1059. Statistics and monitoring
1069.1. CSV format
1079.2. Unix Socket commands
108
109
1101. Quick reminder about HTTP
111----------------------------
112
113When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
114fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
115on almost anything found in the contents.
116
117However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
118formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
119correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
120
121
1221.1. The HTTP transaction model
123-------------------------------
124
125The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100126to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
128connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
129will involve a new connection :
130
131 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
132
133In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
134establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
135by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
136length.
137
138Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
139to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
140however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
141response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
142header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
143
144 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
145
146Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
147power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
148but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
151A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
152keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
153second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
154page :
155
156 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
157
158This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
159latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
160correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
161the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100162server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
165connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
166leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
167start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100169HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
170 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
171 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
172 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
173 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
174 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
175 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
1781.2. HTTP request
179-----------------
180
181First, let's consider this HTTP request :
182
183 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100184 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
186 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
187 3 User-agent: my small browser
188 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
189 5 Accept: image/png
190
191
1921.2.1. The Request line
193-----------------------
194
195Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
196
197 - a METHOD : GET
198 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
199 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
200
201All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
202which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
203followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
204is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
205desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
206the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
207
208The URI itself can have several forms :
209
210 - A "relative URI" :
211
212 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
213
214 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
215 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
216
217 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
218
219 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220
221 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
222 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
223 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
224 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
225 must accept this form too.
226
227 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
228 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
229 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
232 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
233 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
234 other protocols too.
235
236In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
237mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
238on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
239It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
240specific to the language, framework or application in use.
241
242
2431.2.2. The request headers
244--------------------------
245
246The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
247beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
248an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
249Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
250values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
251encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
252the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
253define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
254
255Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
256their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
257"Connection:" header).
258
259The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
260that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
261is one valid form of empty line.
262
263Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
264headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
265about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
266application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
267
268Important note:
269 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
270 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
271 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
272 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
273
274
2751.3. HTTP response
276------------------
277
278An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
279messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
280
281 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100282 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
284 2 Content-length: 350
285 3 Content-Type: text/html
286
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200287As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
288codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
289response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100290continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
291the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
292following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
293sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
294(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
295correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
296such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
297state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
298over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
299if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
300information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302
3031.3.1. The Response line
304------------------------
305
306Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
307
308 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
309 - a status code : 200
310 - a reason : OK
311
312The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200313 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200314 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
315 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
316 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
317 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
318
319Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
322messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
323or "Authentication Required".
324
325Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
326
327 Code When / reason
328 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
329 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100332 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334 400 for an invalid or too large request
335 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
336 accessing the stats page)
337 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
338 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
339 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
340 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
341 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
342 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
343 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
344 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
345 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
346
347The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3484.2).
349
350
3511.3.2. The response headers
352---------------------------
353
354Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
355the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
356details.
357
358
3592. Configuring HAProxy
360----------------------
361
3622.1. Configuration file format
363------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200364
365HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
366
367 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
368 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
369 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
370 "frontend" and "backend".
371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
373referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200374delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003772.2. Quoting and escaping
378-------------------------
379
380HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
381many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
382with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
383single quotes.
384
385If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
386them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
387escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
388
389Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
390
391 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
392 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
393 \\ to use a backslash
394 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
395 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
396
397Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
398the interpretation of:
399
400 space as a parameter separator
401 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
402 # hash as a comment start
403
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200404Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
405-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
406backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
407
408Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200409quoting.
410
411Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
412nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
413
414Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
415equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
416
417 Example:
418 # those are equivalents:
419 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
421 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
424
425 # those are equivalents:
426 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
427 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
430
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004322.3. Environment variables
433--------------------------
434
435HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
436interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
437configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
438optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
439shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
440underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
441
442 Example:
443
444 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
445
446 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
447
448 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
449
450
4512.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200452----------------
453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100454Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100455values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
456otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
457numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
458for every keyword. Supported units are :
459
460 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
461 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
462 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
463 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
464 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
465 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
466
467
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004682.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200469-------------
470
471 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
472 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
473 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
474 global
475 daemon
476 maxconn 256
477
478 defaults
479 mode http
480 timeout connect 5000ms
481 timeout client 50000ms
482 timeout server 50000ms
483
484 frontend http-in
485 bind *:80
486 default_backend servers
487
488 backend servers
489 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
490
491
492 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
493 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
494 global
495 daemon
496 maxconn 256
497
498 defaults
499 mode http
500 timeout connect 5000ms
501 timeout client 50000ms
502 timeout server 50000ms
503
504 listen http-in
505 bind *:80
506 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
507
508
509Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
510
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100511 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200512
513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515--------------------
516
517Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
518are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
519of them have command-line equivalents.
520
521The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
522
523 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200524 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900528 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - gid
530 - group
531 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100532 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200533 - nbproc
534 - pidfile
535 - uid
536 - ulimit-n
537 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200538 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100539 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200540 - node
541 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100542 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100543 - 51degrees-data-file
544 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200545 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200546 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200549 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200551 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100552 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100553 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100554 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200555 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200556 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200557 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558 - noepoll
559 - nokqueue
560 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100561 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300562 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200563 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200564 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200565 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100566 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100567 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200568 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100569 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100570 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100571 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100572 - tune.lua.session-timeout
573 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100574 - tune.maxaccept
575 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200576 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200577 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200578 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100579 - tune.rcvbuf.client
580 - tune.rcvbuf.server
581 - tune.sndbuf.client
582 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100583 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100584 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200585 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100586 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200587 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200588 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200589 - tune.vars.global-max-size
590 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
591 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
592 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100593 - tune.zlib.memlevel
594 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596 * Debugging
597 - debug
598 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006013.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602------------------------------------
603
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200604ca-base <dir>
605 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200606 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
607 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609chroot <jail dir>
610 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
611 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
612 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
613 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
614 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
615 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100616
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100617cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
618 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
619 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
620 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100621 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
622 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
623 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
624 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
625 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
626 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
627 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
628 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
629 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
630 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100631
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200632crt-base <dir>
633 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
634 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
635 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
636
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637daemon
638 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
639 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
640 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
641
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200642deviceatlas-json-file <path>
643 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
644 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
645
646deviceatlas-log-level <value>
647 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
648 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
649
650deviceatlas-separator <char>
651 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
652 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
653
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900654external-check
655 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
656 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
657 See "option external-check".
658
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200659gid <number>
660 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
661 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
662 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100663 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
664 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200665 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100666
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200667group <group name>
668 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
669 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100670
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200671log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
673 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100674 configured with "log global".
675
676 <address> can be one of:
677
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100678 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100679 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
680 port).
681
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100682 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
683 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
684 port).
685
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100686 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
687 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
688 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
689 writeable).
690
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200691 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
692 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100693
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200694 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
695 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
696 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
697 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
698 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
699 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
700 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
701 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
702 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
703 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
704 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
705
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100706 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707
708 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
709 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
710 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
711
712 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200713 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
714 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
715 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
716 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
717 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
718 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200720 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100722log-send-hostname [<string>]
723 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
724 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
725 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
726 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
727 the logs.
728
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000729log-tag <string>
730 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
731 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
732 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100733 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000734
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100735lua-load <file>
736 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
737 used multiple times.
738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200739nbproc <number>
740 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
741 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
742 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
743 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
744 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
745
746pidfile <pidfile>
747 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
748 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
749 starting the process. See also "daemon".
750
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100751stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200752 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
753 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
754 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
755 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
756 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
757 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100758 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200759 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
760 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200761
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100762ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
764 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300765 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100766 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
767 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
768 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
769 "bind" keyword for more information.
770
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100771ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
773 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
774 keyword to see available options.
775
776 Example:
777 global
778 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
779
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100780ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
782 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300783 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100784 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
785 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
786 information.
787
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100788ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
790 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
791 keyword to see available options.
792
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200793ssl-dh-param-file <file>
794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
795 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
796 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
797 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
798 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
799 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them directly
800 in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size specified
801 by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are known to be
802 more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
803 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
804 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
805 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
806
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100807ssl-server-verify [none|required]
808 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
809 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
810 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
811
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200812stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
813 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
814 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
815 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
816 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200817
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200818 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
819 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
820 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200821
822stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
823 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
824 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100825 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200826
827stats maxconn <connections>
828 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
829 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
830
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200831uid <number>
832 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
833 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
834 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
835 one. See also "gid" and "user".
836
837ulimit-n <number>
838 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
839 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
840 option.
841
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100842unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
843 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
844
845 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
846 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
847 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
848 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
849 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
850 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
851 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
852 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
853 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
854 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
855
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200856user <user name>
857 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
858 See also "uid" and "group".
859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200860node <name>
861 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
862
863 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
864 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
865 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
866 traffic.
867
868description <text>
869 Add a text that describes the instance.
870
871 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
872 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
873 "<" and ">" characters.
874
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010087551degrees-data-file <file path>
876 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
877 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
878
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200879 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100880 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
881
88251degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
883 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
884 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
885 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
886
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200887 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100888 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
889
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020089051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100891 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
892 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
893
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200894 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
895 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
896
89751degrees-cache-size <number>
898 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
899 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
900 By default, this cache is disabled.
901
902 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100903 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
904
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009063.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200907-----------------------
908
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200909max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
910 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
911 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
912 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
913 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
914 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
915 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
916 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
917 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919maxconn <number>
920 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
921 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
922 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200923 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
924 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
925 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
926 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100927 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
928 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
929 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
930 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
931 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200933maxconnrate <number>
934 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
935 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
936 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
937 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
938 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
939 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
940 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
941 fairness.
942
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100943maxcomprate <number>
944 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300945 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100946 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
947 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
948 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
949 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
950 default value.
951
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100952maxcompcpuusage <number>
953 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
954 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
955 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
956 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
957 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
958 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
959 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
960 process down and from introducing high latencies.
961
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100962maxpipes <number>
963 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
964 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
965 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
966 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
967 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
968 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
969
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200970maxsessrate <number>
971 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
972 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
973 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
974 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
975 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
976 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
977 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
978 fairness.
979
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200980maxsslconn <number>
981 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
982 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
983 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
984 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
985 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
986 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
987 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100988 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
989 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
990 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
991 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
992 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
993 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
994 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200995
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200996maxsslrate <number>
997 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
998 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
999 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1000 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1001 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1002 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1003 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1004 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1005 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1006 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1007
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001008maxzlibmem <number>
1009 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1010 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1011 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001012 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1013 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1014 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1015
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016noepoll
1017 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1018 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001019 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
1021nokqueue
1022 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1025
1026nopoll
1027 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1028 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001029 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001030 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001032nosplice
1033 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1034 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1035 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001036 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001037 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1038 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1039 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1040 "option splice-response".
1041
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001042nogetaddrinfo
1043 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1044 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1045
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001046spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001047 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1048 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1049 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1050 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1051 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1052 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001053
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001054tune.buffers.limit <number>
1055 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1056 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1057 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1058 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1059 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1060 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1061 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1062 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1063 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1064 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1065 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1066 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1067 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1068 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1069 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1070
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001071tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1072 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1073 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1074 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1075 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1076
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001077tune.bufsize <number>
1078 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1079 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1080 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1081 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1082 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1083 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1084 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1085 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001086 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1087 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1088 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001089
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001090tune.chksize <number>
1091 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1092 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1093 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1094 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1095 checks whenever possible.
1096
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001097tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1098 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1099 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1100 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1101 this value. The default value is 1.
1102
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001103tune.http.cookielen <number>
1104 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1105 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1106 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1107 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1108 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1109 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1110 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1111 to change this value.
1112
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001113tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1114 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1115 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1116 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1117 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1118 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1119 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1120 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1121 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1122 limit too high.
1123
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001124tune.idletimer <timeout>
1125 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1126 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1127 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1128 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1129 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1130 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1131 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1132 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1133 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1134
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001135tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1136 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1137 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1138 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1139 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1140 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1141 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1142 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1143
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001144tune.lua.maxmem
1145 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1146 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1147 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1148 memory.
1149
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001150tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1151 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1152 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1153 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1154 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1155 4s.
1156
1157tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1158 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1159 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1160 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1161 check servers.
1162
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001163tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001164 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1165 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1166 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1167 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1168 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1169 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1170 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1171 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1172 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1173 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001174
1175tune.maxpollevents <number>
1176 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1177 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1178 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1179 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1180 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1181
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001182tune.maxrewrite <number>
1183 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1184 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1185 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1186 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1187 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1188 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1189 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1190 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1191 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1192 bufsize.
1193
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001194tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1195 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1196 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1197 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1198 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1199 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1200 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1201 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1202 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1203 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1204 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1205 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1206 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1207 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1208 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1209 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1210 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1211 setting this parameter to 0.
1212
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001213tune.pipesize <number>
1214 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1215 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1216 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1217 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1218 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1219 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1220
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001221tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1222tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1223 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1224 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1225 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1226 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1227 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1228 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1229 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1230
1231tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1232tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1233 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1234 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1235 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1236 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1237 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1238 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1239 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1240 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1241 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1242 notifying haproxy again.
1243
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001244tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001245 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1246 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1247 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001248 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001249 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1250 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1251 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1252 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1253 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001254 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1255 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001256
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001257tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1258 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1259 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1260 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1261 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1262 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1263 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1264
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001265tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1266 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001267 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001268 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1269 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1270 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1271 being used for too long.
1272
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001273tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1274 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1275 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1276 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1277 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1278 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1279 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1280 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1281 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1282 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1283 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001284 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1285 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001286
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001287tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1288 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1289 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1290 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1291 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1292 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1293 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1294 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001295 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1296 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001297
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001298tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1299 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1300 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1301 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1302 1000 entries.
1303
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001304tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1305tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1306tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1307tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
1308 These four tunes helps to manage the allowed amount of memory used by the
1309 variables system. "global" limits the memory for all the systems. "sess" limit
1310 the memory by session, "txn" limits the memory by transaction and "reqres"
1311 limits the memory for each request or response processing. during the
1312 accounting, "sess" embbed "txn" and "txn" embed "reqres".
1313
1314 By example, we considers that "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is fixed to 100,
1315 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" is fixed to 100, "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" is
1316 also fixed to 100. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1317 we cannot create any more variable in the other contexts.
1318
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001319tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1320 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001321 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001322 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1323 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1324 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1325
1326tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1327 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1328 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1329 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1330 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013323.3. Debugging
1333--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001334
1335debug
1336 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1337 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1338 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1339 system startup.
1340
1341quiet
1342 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1343 line argument "-q".
1344
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013463.4. Userlists
1347--------------
1348It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1349http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1350it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1351
1352userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001353 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001354 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1355
1356group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001357 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001358 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1359 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1360
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001361user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1362 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001363 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1364 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001365 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1366 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001367 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001368 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001369
1370
1371 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001372 userlist L1
1373 group G1 users tiger,scott
1374 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001375
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001376 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1377 user scott insecure-password elgato
1378 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001379
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001380 userlist L2
1381 group G1
1382 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001383
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001384 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1385 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1386 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001387
1388 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001389
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001390
13913.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001392----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001393It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1394several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1395instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1396values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1397automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1398In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1399using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1400tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1401reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1402Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1403that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1404each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001405
1406peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001407 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001408 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1409
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001410disabled
1411 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1412 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1413 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1414
1415enable
1416 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1417
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001418peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1419 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1420 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1421 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1422 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1423 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1424 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1425
1426 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1427 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1428
1429 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1430 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1431 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1432 across all peers.
1433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001434 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1435 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001436
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001437 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001438 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001439 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1440 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1441 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001442
1443 backend mybackend
1444 mode tcp
1445 balance roundrobin
1446 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1447 stick on src
1448
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001449 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1450 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001451
1452
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090014533.6. Mailers
1454------------
1455It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1456If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1457in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1458
1459mailer <mailersect>
1460 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1461 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1462
1463mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1464 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1465
1466 Example:
1467 mailers mymailers
1468 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1469 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1470
1471 backend mybackend
1472 mode tcp
1473 balance roundrobin
1474
1475 email-alert mailers mymailers
1476 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1477 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1478
1479 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1480 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1481
1482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014834. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001484----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001486Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001487 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001488 - frontend <name>
1489 - backend <name>
1490 - listen <name>
1491
1492A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1493its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1494section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001495section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001496
1497A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1498connections.
1499
1500A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1501to forward incoming connections.
1502
1503A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1504parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001506All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1507'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1508case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1509
1510Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1511logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1512proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1513However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1514name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1515
1516Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1517and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001518bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001519protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1520modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1521arbitrary criteria.
1522
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001523In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1524a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1525the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1526
1527 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1528 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1529 between responses and new requests.
1530
1531 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1532 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1533 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1534 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1535
1536 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1537 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1538 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1539
1540 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1541 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1542 client-facing connection remains open.
1543
1544 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1545 after the end of the response.
1546
1547The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1548frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1549following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1550weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1551
1552 Backend mode
1553
1554 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1555 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1556 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1557 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1558 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1559 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1560 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1561 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1562 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1563 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1564 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001566
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015684.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1569--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001571The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1572limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1573they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1574limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001575marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001576option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001577and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1578with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1579specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001582 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1583------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1584acl - X X X
1585appsession - - X X
1586backlog X X X -
1587balance X - X X
1588bind - X X -
1589bind-process X X X X
1590block - X X X
1591capture cookie - X X -
1592capture request header - X X -
1593capture response header - X X -
1594clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001595compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001596contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1597cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001598declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001599default-server X - X X
1600default_backend X X X -
1601description - X X X
1602disabled X X X X
1603dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001604email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001605email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001606email-alert mailers X X X X
1607email-alert myhostname X X X X
1608email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001609enabled X X X X
1610errorfile X X X X
1611errorloc X X X X
1612errorloc302 X X X X
1613-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1614errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001615force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001616fullconn X - X X
1617grace X X X X
1618hash-type X - X X
1619http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001620http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001621http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001622http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001623http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001624http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001625id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001626ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001627log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001628log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001629log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001630max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001631maxconn X X X -
1632mode X X X X
1633monitor fail - X X -
1634monitor-net X X X -
1635monitor-uri X X X -
1636option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1637option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1638option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1639option allbackups (*) X - X X
1640option checkcache (*) X - X X
1641option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1642option contstats (*) X X X -
1643option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1644option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1645option forceclose (*) X X X X
1646-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1647option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001648option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001649option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001650option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001651option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001652option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001653option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001654option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001655option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1656option httpchk X - X X
1657option httpclose (*) X X X X
1658option httplog X X X X
1659option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001660option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001661option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001662option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001663option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1664option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1665option logasap (*) X X X -
1666option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001667option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001668option nolinger (*) X X X X
1669option originalto X X X X
1670option persist (*) X - X X
1671option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001672option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001673option smtpchk X - X X
1674option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1675option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1676option splice-request (*) X X X X
1677option splice-response (*) X X X X
1678option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1679option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1680-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001681option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001682option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1683option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1684option tcpka X X X X
1685option tcplog X X X X
1686option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001687external-check command X - X X
1688external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001689persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1690rate-limit sessions X X X -
1691redirect - X X X
1692redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1693redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1694reqadd - X X X
1695reqallow - X X X
1696reqdel - X X X
1697reqdeny - X X X
1698reqiallow - X X X
1699reqidel - X X X
1700reqideny - X X X
1701reqipass - X X X
1702reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001703reqitarpit - X X X
1704reqpass - X X X
1705reqrep - X X X
1706-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001707reqtarpit - X X X
1708retries X - X X
1709rspadd - X X X
1710rspdel - X X X
1711rspdeny - X X X
1712rspidel - X X X
1713rspideny - X X X
1714rspirep - X X X
1715rsprep - X X X
1716server - - X X
1717source X - X X
1718srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001719stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001720stats auth X - X X
1721stats enable X - X X
1722stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001723stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001724stats realm X - X X
1725stats refresh X - X X
1726stats scope X - X X
1727stats show-desc X - X X
1728stats show-legends X - X X
1729stats show-node X - X X
1730stats uri X - X X
1731-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1732stick match - - X X
1733stick on - - X X
1734stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001735stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001736stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001737tcp-check connect - - X X
1738tcp-check expect - - X X
1739tcp-check send - - X X
1740tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001741tcp-request connection - X X -
1742tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001743tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001744tcp-response content - - X X
1745tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001746timeout check X - X X
1747timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001748timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001749timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1750timeout connect X - X X
1751timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1752timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1753timeout http-request X X X X
1754timeout queue X - X X
1755timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001756timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001757timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1758timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001759timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001760transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001761unique-id-format X X X -
1762unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001763use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001764use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001765------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1766 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001767
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017694.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1770---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771
1772This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1773
1774
1775acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1776 Declare or complete an access list.
1777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1778 no | yes | yes | yes
1779 Example:
1780 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1781 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1782 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001784 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785
1786
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001787appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1788 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1791 no | no | yes | yes
1792 Arguments :
1793 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1794 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1795
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001796 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797 checked in each cookie value.
1798
1799 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1800 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1801 milliseconds.
1802
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001803 request-learn
1804 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1805 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1806 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1807 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1808 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1809 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1810
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001811 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1812 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1813 data following this prefix.
1814
1815 Example :
1816 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1817
1818 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1819 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1820
1821 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1822 2 modes are currently supported :
1823 - path-parameters :
1824 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1825 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1826 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1827 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1828 - query-string :
1829 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1830 query string.
1831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1833 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1834 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1835 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001836 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1837 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1838 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001839 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1840 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1841
1842 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1843
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001844 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1845 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1846 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1847
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848 Example :
1849 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1850
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001851 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1852 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001853
1854
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001855backlog <conns>
1856 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1858 yes | yes | yes | no
1859 Arguments :
1860 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1861 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001862 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001863
1864 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1865 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1866 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1867 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1868 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1869 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1870 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1871 backlog parameter.
1872
1873 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1874 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1875 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1876
1877 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1878
1879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001880balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001881balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001882 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1884 yes | no | yes | yes
1885 Arguments :
1886 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1887 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1888 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1889 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1890
1891 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1892 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1893 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1894 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001895 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001896 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001897 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1898 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1899 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1900 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1901 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1902 it, so that you don't worry.
1903
1904 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1905 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1906 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1907 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1908 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1909 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1910 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1911 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001912
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001913 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1914 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1915 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1916 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1917 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1918 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1919 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1920 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1921
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001922 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001923 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001924 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1925 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001926 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001927 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1928 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1929 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1930 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1931 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001932 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1933 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1934 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1935 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1936 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1937 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001938
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001939 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1940 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1941 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1942 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1943 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1944 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1945 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1946 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001947 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001949 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1950 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1951 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001952
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001953 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1954 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1955 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1956 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1957 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1958 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1959 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1960 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1961 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1962 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1963 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1964 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001966 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001967 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1968 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1969 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1970 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1971 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1972 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1973 URIs start with a leading "/".
1974
1975 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1976 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1977 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1978 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1979
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001980 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001981 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1982
1983 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001984 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1985 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001986 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1987 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1988 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1989 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001990 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001991 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1992 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001993
1994 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1995 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1996 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1997 server will receive the request.
1998
1999 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2000 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2001 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2002 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2003 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002004 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2005 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2006 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002008 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2009 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2010 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2011 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2012 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002014 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002015 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2016 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2017 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2018
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002019 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2020 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2021 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2022
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002023 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002024 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002025 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2026 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2027 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2028 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2029 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2030 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002031 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002032 used instead.
2033
2034 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2035 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2036 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2037 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2038
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002039 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2040 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2041 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2042
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002043 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002046 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2047 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002048
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002049 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2050 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2051 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052
2053 Examples :
2054 balance roundrobin
2055 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002056 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002057 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2058 balance hdr(host)
2059 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002060
2061 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2062 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002064 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002065 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2066 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2067 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2068 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2069
2070 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2071 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2072 defaults to 16 kB.
2073
2074 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2075 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2076
2077 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2078 Round Robin.
2079
2080 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2081 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2082 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2083 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2084
2085 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2086
2087 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002088 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002089 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2090 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2091 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002093 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
2094 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095
2096
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002097bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2098bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2101 no | yes | yes | no
2102 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002103 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2104 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2105 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2106 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002107 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002108 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2109 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2110 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2111 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2112 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2113 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2114 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002115 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2116 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2117 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2118 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2119 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2120 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2121 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002122 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2123 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2124 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002125 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2126 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2127 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002128
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002129 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2130 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002131 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2132 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2133 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002134 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2135 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2136 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2137 the range.
2138
2139 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2140 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2141 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2142 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2143 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2144 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2145 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002146 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002147 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002148
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002149 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2150 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2151 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2152 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2153 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2154 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2155 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2156 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2157
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002158 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2159 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2160 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2161 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002162
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2164 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2165 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2166 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2167 in a frontend.
2168
2169 Example :
2170 listen http_proxy
2171 bind :80,:443
2172 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002173 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002174
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002175 listen http_https_proxy
2176 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002177 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002178
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002179 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2180 bind ipv6@:80
2181 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2182 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2183
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002184 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002185 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002186
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002187 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002188 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002189
2190
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002191bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002192 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2194 yes | yes | yes | yes
2195 Arguments :
2196 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2197 may be used to override a default value.
2198
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002199 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002200 option may be combined with other numbers.
2201
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002202 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002203 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2204 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2205 missing from all processes.
2206
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002207 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002208 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002209 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2210 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2211 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2212 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002213
2214 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2215 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2216 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2217 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2218 and 'even' instances.
2219
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002220 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2221 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2222 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2223 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002224
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002225 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2226 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2227
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002228 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2229 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2230 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2231
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002232 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2233 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2234
2235 Example :
2236 listen app_ip1
2237 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002238 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002239
2240 listen app_ip2
2241 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002242 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002243
2244 listen management
2245 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002246 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002247
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002248 listen management
2249 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2250 bind-process 1-4
2251
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002252 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002253
2254
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255block { if | unless } <condition>
2256 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2258 no | yes | yes | yes
2259
2260 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2261 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002262 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002263 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002264 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2265 "block" statements per instance.
2266
2267 Example:
2268 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2269 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2270 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2271 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002273 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
2275
2276capture cookie <name> len <length>
2277 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2279 no | yes | yes | no
2280 Arguments :
2281 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2282 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2283 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2284 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2285 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2286
2287 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2288 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2289 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2290 right if it exceeds <length>.
2291
2292 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2293 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2294 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2295 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2296
2297 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2298 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2299 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2300
2301 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2302 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2303 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002304 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2305 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2306 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307
2308 Example:
2309 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2310
2311 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002312 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002313
2314
2315capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002316 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2318 no | yes | yes | no
2319 Arguments :
2320 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002321 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002322 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2323 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2324 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2325
2326 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2327 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2328 it exceeds <length>.
2329
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002330 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002331 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2332 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002333 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2334 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2335 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2336 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002337 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002338 environments to find where the request came from.
2339
2340 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2341 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2342 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2343 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002344
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002345 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2346 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2347 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2348 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2349 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002350
2351 Example:
2352 capture request header Host len 15
2353 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2354 capture request header Referrer len 15
2355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002356 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002357 about logging.
2358
2359
2360capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002361 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2363 no | yes | yes | no
2364 Arguments :
2365 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002366 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002367 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2368 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2369 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2370
2371 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2372 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2373 it exceeds <length>.
2374
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002375 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002376 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2377 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2378 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002379 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2380 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2381 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2382 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002384 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2385 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2386 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2387 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2388 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389
2390 Example:
2391 capture response header Content-length len 9
2392 capture response header Location len 15
2393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002394 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395 about logging.
2396
2397
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002398clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2401 yes | yes | yes | no
2402 Arguments :
2403 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2404 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2405 as explained at the top of this document.
2406
2407 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2408 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2409 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2410 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2411 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2412 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2413 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2414 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002415 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002416 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2417 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2418
2419 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2420 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2421 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2422 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2423 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2424 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2425
2426 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2427 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2428
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002429 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2430 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002431
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002432compression algo <algorithm> ...
2433compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002434compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002435 Enable HTTP compression.
2436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2437 yes | yes | yes | yes
2438 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002439 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2440 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2441 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2442
2443 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002444 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2445 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2446 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002447
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002448 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2449 support for zlib was built in.
2450
2451 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2452 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2453 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2454 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2455 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2456 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002457
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002458 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2459 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2460 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2461 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2462 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2463 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2464 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2465 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002466
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002467 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002468 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002469 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2470 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2471 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2472 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2473 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002474
2475 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2476 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2477 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2478 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2479 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002480 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2481 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2482 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2483 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2484 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002485 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2486 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002487
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002488 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002489 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2490 "Accept-Encoding" header
2491 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002492 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002493 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2494 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002495 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2496 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2497 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2498 "multipart"
2499 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2500 header
2501 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2502 and later
2503 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2504 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002505
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002506 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2507 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002508
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002509 Examples :
2510 compression algo gzip
2511 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002512
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002513contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002514 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2516 yes | no | yes | yes
2517 Arguments :
2518 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2519 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2520 as explained at the top of this document.
2521
2522 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002523 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002524 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002525 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2526 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2527 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2528 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2529
2530 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2531 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2532 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2533 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2534 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2535 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2536
2537 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2538 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2539 instead.
2540
2541 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2542 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2543
2544
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002545cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002546 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2547 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2550 yes | no | yes | yes
2551 Arguments :
2552 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2553 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2554 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2555 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2556 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2557 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2558 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2559 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2560 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2561
2562 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2563 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2564 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2565 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2566 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2567 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2568 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2569 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2570 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2571 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2572 "insert" and "prefix".
2573
2574 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002575 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002576
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002577 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002578 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2579 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2580 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2581 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2582 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2583 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2584 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2585 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2586 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2587 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588
2589 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2590 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2591 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2592 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2593 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2594 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2595 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2596 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2597 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2598 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002599 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2600 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2601 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002602
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002603 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2604 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2605 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002606 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2607 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2608 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2609 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002610 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2611 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2612 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002613
2614 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2615 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2616 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2617 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2618 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2619 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2620 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2621 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2622 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2623
2624 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2625 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2626 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2627 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2628 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2629 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2630 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2631 persistence cookie in the cache.
2632 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2633
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002634 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2635 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2636 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2637 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2638 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2639 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2640 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2641 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2642 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2643 they logout.
2644
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002645 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2646 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2647 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2648 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2649
2650 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2651 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2652 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2653 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2654 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2655 this attribute.
2656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002657 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002658 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002659 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2660 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2661 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2662 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2663 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2664 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002665
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002666 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2667 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2668 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2669 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2670 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2671 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2672 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2673 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2674 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2675 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2676 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2677 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2678 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2679 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2680 the site.
2681
2682 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2683 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2684 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2685 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2686 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2687 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2688 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2689 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2690 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2691 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2692 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2693 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2694 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2695 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2696 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2697 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2698
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002699 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2700 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2701 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2702 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002704 Examples :
2705 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2706 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2707 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002708 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002709
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002710 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002711 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002713
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002714declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2715 Declares a capture slot.
2716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2717 no | yes | yes | no
2718 Arguments:
2719 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2720
2721 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2722 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2723 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2724 for use in the response.
2725
2726 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2727 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2728
2729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002730default-server [param*]
2731 Change default options for a server in a backend
2732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2733 yes | no | yes | yes
2734 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002735 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2736 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2737 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2738 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002739
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002740 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002741 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2742
2743 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002744
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746default_backend <backend>
2747 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2749 yes | yes | yes | no
2750 Arguments :
2751 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2752
2753 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2754 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2755 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2756 will catch all undetermined requests.
2757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758 Example :
2759
2760 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2761 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2762 default_backend dynamic
2763
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002764 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002767description <string>
2768 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2770 no | yes | yes | yes
2771 Arguments : string
2772
2773 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2774 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2775 it describes.
2776 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2777
2778
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002779disabled
2780 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2782 yes | yes | yes | yes
2783 Arguments : none
2784
2785 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2786 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2787 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2788 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2789 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2790 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2791 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2792
2793 See also : "enabled"
2794
2795
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002796dispatch <address>:<port>
2797 Set a default server address
2798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2799 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002800 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002801
2802 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2803 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2804 during start-up.
2805
2806 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2807 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2808 possible with normal servers.
2809
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002810 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002811 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2812 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2813 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2814 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2815
2816 See also : "server"
2817
2818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819enabled
2820 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2822 yes | yes | yes | yes
2823 Arguments : none
2824
2825 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2826 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2827
2828 See also : "disabled"
2829
2830
2831errorfile <code> <file>
2832 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2834 yes | yes | yes | yes
2835 Arguments :
2836 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002837 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2838 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002839
2840 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002841 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002842 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002843 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2844 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845
2846 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2847 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2848 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2849
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002850 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002852 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2853 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2854 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2855 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2856
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002857 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2858 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2859 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2860 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2861 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2862 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2865 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2866 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002867 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2869
2870 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2871
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002872 Example :
2873 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002874 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002875 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2876 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2877
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002878
2879errorloc <code> <url>
2880errorloc302 <code> <url>
2881 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2883 yes | yes | yes | yes
2884 Arguments :
2885 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002886 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002887
2888 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2889 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2890 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2891 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2892 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2893
2894 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2895 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2896 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2897
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002898 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2899
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002900 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2901 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2902 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2903 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2904 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2905 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2906 request.
2907
2908 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2909
2910
2911errorloc303 <code> <url>
2912 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2914 yes | yes | yes | yes
2915 Arguments :
2916 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2917 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2918
2919 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2920 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2921 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2922 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2923 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2924
2925 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2926 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2927 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2928
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002929 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2930
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002931 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2932 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2933 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2934 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002935 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002936
2937 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2938
2939
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002940email-alert from <emailaddr>
2941 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2942 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2943 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2944 yes | yes | yes | yes
2945
2946 Arguments :
2947
2948 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2949
2950 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2951 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2952
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002953 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2954 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2955
2956
2957email-alert level <level>
2958 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2959 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2961 yes | yes | yes | yes
2962
2963 Arguments :
2964
2965 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2966 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2967 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2968
2969 By default level is alert
2970
2971 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2972 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2973 for the proxy.
2974
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002975 Alerts are sent when :
2976
2977 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2978 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2979 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2980 is notice or lower
2981 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2982 and a health check status update occurs
2983
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002984 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2985 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002986 section 3.6 about mailers.
2987
2988
2989email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2990 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2992 yes | yes | yes | yes
2993
2994 Arguments :
2995
2996 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2997
2998 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2999 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3000
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003001 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3002 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003003
3004
3005email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3006 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3007 mailers.
3008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3009 yes | yes | yes | yes
3010
3011 Arguments :
3012
3013 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3014
3015 By default the systems hostname is used.
3016
3017 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3018 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3019 for the proxy.
3020
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003021 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3022 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003023
3024
3025email-alert to <emailaddr>
3026 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3027 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3029 yes | yes | yes | yes
3030
3031 Arguments :
3032
3033 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3034
3035 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3036 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3037
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003038 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003039 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3040
3041
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003042force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3043 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3044 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3045 no | yes | yes | yes
3046
3047 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3048 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3049 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3050 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3051 marked down for maintenance operations.
3052
3053 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3054 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3055 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3056 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3057 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3058 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3059 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3060 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3061 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3062
3063 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3064 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3065 is used.
3066
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003067 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003068 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003069
3070
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003071fullconn <conns>
3072 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 yes | no | yes | yes
3075 Arguments :
3076 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3077 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3078
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003079 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003080 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003081 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003082 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3083 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3084 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3085 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3086 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003087 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003088
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003089 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3090 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003091 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3092 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3093 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003094
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003095 Example :
3096 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3097 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3098 # connections.
3099 backend dynamic
3100 fullconn 10000
3101 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3102 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3103
3104 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3105
3106
3107grace <time>
3108 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003110 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003111 Arguments :
3112 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3113 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3114 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3115
3116 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3117 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003118 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003119 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3120
3121 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3122 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3123 simplify it.
3124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003125
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003126hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003127 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3129 yes | no | yes | yes
3130 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003131 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3132 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003133
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003134 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3135 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3136 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3137 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3138 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3139 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3140 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3141 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3142 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3143 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003144
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003145 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3146 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3147 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3148 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3149 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3150 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3151 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3152 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3153 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3154 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3155 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3156 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3157 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003158 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3159 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003160
3161 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3162
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003163 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003164 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3165 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3166 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003167 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3168 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3169 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003170
3171 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3172 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003173 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3174 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3175 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3176 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3177
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003178 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3179 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3180 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3181 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3182 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3183 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3184 parameter.
3185
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003186 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3187 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3188 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3189 used on strings.
3190
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003191 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3192
3193 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3194 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3195 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3196 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3197 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3198 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3199 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3200 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3201 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3202 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3203 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3204 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003205
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003206 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3207 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3208 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003209
3210 See also : "balance", "server"
3211
3212
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003213http-check disable-on-404
3214 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003216 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003217 Arguments : none
3218
3219 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3220 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3221 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3222 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3223 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3224 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3225 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3226 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003227 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3228 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3229 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3230
3231 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3232
3233
3234http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003235 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003237 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003238 Arguments :
3239 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3240 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003241 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003242 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3243 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3244 details on the supported keywords.
3245
3246 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3247 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3248 with the usual backslash ('\').
3249
3250 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3251 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3252 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3253 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3254 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3255
3256 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003257 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003258 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3259 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3260 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3261
3262 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003263 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003264 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3265 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3266 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3267 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3268
3269 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003270 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003271 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3272 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3273 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3274 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3275 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3276 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3277 trace).
3278
3279 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003280 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003281 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3282 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3283 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3284 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3285 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3286 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3287
3288 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3289 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3290 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3291 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3292 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3293 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3294 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3295 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3296
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003297 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3298 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3299 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3300
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003301 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3302 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3303
3304 Examples :
3305 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003306 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003307
3308 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003309 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003310
3311 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003312 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003313
3314 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003315 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003316
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003317 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003318
3319
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003320http-check send-state
3321 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3323 yes | no | yes | yes
3324 Arguments : none
3325
3326 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3327 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3328 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3329 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3330 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3331
3332 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3333 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3334 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3335 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3336 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003337 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3338 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3339 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3340
3341 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3342 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3343 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3344
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003345 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3346 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3347 checked in multiple backends.
3348
3349 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3350 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3351
3352 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3353 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3354 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3355 one fails.
3356
3357 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3358 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3359 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3360
3361 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3362 server's queue.
3363
3364 Example of a header received by the application server :
3365 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3366 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3367
3368 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3369
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003370http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003371 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003372 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003373 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003374 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3375 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003376 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3377 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003378 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3379 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3380 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003381 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003382 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003383 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3384 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003385 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003386 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003387 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3388
3389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3390 no | yes | yes | yes
3391
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003392 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3393 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3394 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3395 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3396 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003397
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003398 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3399 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3400 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3401
3402 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3403 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3404 are evaluated.
3405
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003406 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3407 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3408 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3409 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3410 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3411 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3412 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3413 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3414 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003415 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003416 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3417
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003418 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3419 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3420 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3421 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3422 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3423
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003424 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3425 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3426 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003427 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3428 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003429
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003430 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3431 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3432 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3433 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3434 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3435 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3436 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3437 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3438
3439 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3440 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3441 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003442 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3443 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003444
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003445 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3446 <name>.
3447
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003448 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3449 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3450 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3451 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3452 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3453 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3454 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3455 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3456
3457 Example:
3458
3459 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3460
3461 applied to:
3462
3463 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3464
3465 outputs:
3466
3467 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3468
3469 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3470
3471 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3472 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3473 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3474 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3475 header.
3476
3477 Example:
3478
3479 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3480
3481 applied to:
3482
3483 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3484
3485 outputs:
3486
3487 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3488
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003489 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3490 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3491 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3492 it.
3493
3494 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3495 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3496 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3497 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3498 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3499 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3500
3501 Example :
3502 # prepend the host name before the path
3503 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3504
3505 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3506 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3507 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3508 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3509 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3510 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3511 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3512 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3513
3514 Example :
3515 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3516 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3517
3518 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3519 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3520 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3521 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3522 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3523 "set-query".
3524
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003525 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3526 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3527 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3528 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3529 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3530 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3531 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3532 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3533
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003534 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3535 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3536 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3537 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3538 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3539 another equipment.
3540
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003541 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3542 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3543 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3544 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3545 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3546 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3547 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3548 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3549
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003550 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3551 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3552 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3553 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3554 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3555 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3556 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3557 admin privileges.
3558
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003559 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3560 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3561 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3562 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3563 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3564 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3565 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3566 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3567
3568 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3569 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3570 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3571 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3572 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3573 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3574
3575 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3576 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3577 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3578 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3579 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3580 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3581
3582 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3583 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3584 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3585 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3586 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3587 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3588 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3589 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3590 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3591
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003592 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003593 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3594 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3595 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3596 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3597 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3598 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3599 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3600 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3601 request header" for more information.
3602
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003603 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3604 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3605 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3606 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3607
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003608 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3609 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3610 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3611 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3612 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3613 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3614 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3615 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3616 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3617 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3618 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3619 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3620
3621 These actions take one or two arguments :
3622 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3623 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3624 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3625 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3626
3627 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3628 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3629 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3630 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3631
3632 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3633 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3634 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3635 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3636 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3637 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3638 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3639 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3640
3641 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3642 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3643 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3644 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3645 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3646
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003647 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3648 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3649 function is documented in the API documentation.
3650
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003651 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3652 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3653 inline.
3654
3655 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3656 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3657 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3658 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3659 (request and response)
3660 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3661 processing
3662 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3663 processing.
3664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3665 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3666 and '_'.
3667
3668 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3669 followed by some converters.
3670
3671 Example:
3672
3673 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3674
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003675 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3676
3677 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3678 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3679 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3680 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003681
3682 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003683 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3684 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3685 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003686
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003687 http-request allow if nagios
3688 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3689 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3690 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003691
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003692 Example:
3693 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003694 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003695
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003696 Example:
3697 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3698 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3699 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3700 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3701 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3702 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3703 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3704 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3705 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3706
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003707 Example:
3708 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3709 acl add path /addacl
3710 acl del path /delacl
3711
3712 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3713
3714 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3715 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3716
3717 Example:
3718 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3719 acl setmap path /setmap
3720 acl delmap path /delmap
3721
3722 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3723
3724 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3725 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3726
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003727 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3728 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003729
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003730http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003731 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003732 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003733 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3734 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003735 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3736 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3737 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3738 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003739 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003740 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003741 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003742 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003743 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003744 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3745
3746 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 no | yes | yes | yes
3748
3749 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3750 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3751 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3752 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3753 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3754 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3755
3756 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3757 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3758 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3759 current section.
3760
3761 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3762 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3763 rules are evaluated.
3764
3765 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3766 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3767 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3768 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3769 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3770 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3771 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3772
3773 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3774 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3775 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3776 external users.
3777
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003778 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3779 <name>.
3780
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003781 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3782 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3783 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3784 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3785 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3786 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3787 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3788 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3789
3790 Example:
3791
3792 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3793
3794 applied to:
3795
3796 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3797
3798 outputs:
3799
3800 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3801
3802 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3803
3804 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3805 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3806 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3807 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3808 header.
3809
3810 Example:
3811
3812 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3813
3814 applied to:
3815
3816 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3817
3818 outputs:
3819
3820 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3821
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003822 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3823 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3824 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3825 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3826 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3827 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3828 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3829 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3830
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003831 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3832 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3833 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3834 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3835 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3836 another equipment.
3837
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003838 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3839 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3840 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3841 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3842 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3843 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3844 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3845 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3846
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003847 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3848 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3849 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3850 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3851 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3852 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3853 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3854 admin privileges.
3855
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003856 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3857 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3858 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3859 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3860 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3861 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3862 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3863 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3864
3865 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3866 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3867 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3868 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3869 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3870 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3871
3872 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3873 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3874 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3875 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3876 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3877 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3878
3879 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3880 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3881 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3882 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3883 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3884 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3885 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3886 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3887 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3888
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003889 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3890 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3891 function is documented in the API documentation.
3892
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003893 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3894 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3895 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3896 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3897 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3898 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3899 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3900 response header" for more information.
3901
3902 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3903 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3904 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3905 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3906 keyword.
3907
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003908 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3909 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3910 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3911 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3912 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3913 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3914
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003915 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
3916 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3917 inline.
3918
3919 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3920 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3921 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3922 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3923 (request and response)
3924 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3925 processing
3926 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3927 processing.
3928 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3929 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3930 and '_'.
3931
3932 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3933 followed by some converters.
3934
3935 Example:
3936
3937 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
3938
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003939 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3940
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003941 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003942 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3943 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3944 rules.
3945
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003946 Example:
3947 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3948
3949 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3950
3951 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3952 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3953
3954 Example:
3955 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3956
3957 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3958
3959 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3960 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3961
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003962 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3963 ACL usage.
3964
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003965
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003966http-send-name-header [<header>]
3967 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3968
3969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3970 yes | no | yes | yes
3971
3972 Arguments :
3973
3974 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3975
3976 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3977 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3978 is added with the header string proved.
3979
3980 See also : "server"
3981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003982id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003983 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3985 no | yes | yes | yes
3986 Arguments : none
3987
3988 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3989 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3990 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003991
3992
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003993ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3994 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 no | yes | yes | yes
3997
3998 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3999 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4000 and running).
4001
4002 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4003 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4004 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004005 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004006 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4007
4008 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
4009 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
4010
4011 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4012 "unless" condition is met.
4013
4014 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4015
4016
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004017log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004018log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004019no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004020 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4022 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004023
4024 Prefix :
4025 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4026 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4027 prefix does not allow arguments.
4028
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004029 Arguments :
4030 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4031 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4032 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4033 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4034 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4035 parameter.
4036
4037 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4038 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4039
4040 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4041 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4042 standard syslog port).
4043
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004044 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4045 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4046 standard syslog port).
4047
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004048 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4049 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4050 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4051 appropriately writeable).
4052
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004053 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4054 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004055
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004056 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4057 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4058 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4059 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4060 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4061 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4062 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4063 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4064 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4065 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4066 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4067
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004068 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4069
4070 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4071 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4072 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4073
4074 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4075 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4076 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004077 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4078 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4079 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4080 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4081 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004082
4083 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4084
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004085 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4086 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4087 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004088
4089 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4090 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4091 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4092 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4093
4094 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4095 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004096
4097 Example :
4098 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004099 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4100 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004101 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004102
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004103
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004104log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004105 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4106 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4107 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004108
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004109 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4110 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4111 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4112 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4113 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004114
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004115log-tag <string>
4116 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4117 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4118 yes | yes | yes | yes
4119
4120 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4121 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4122 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4123 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4124 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4125 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4126 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4127 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4128 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004129
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004130max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4131 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4132 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4133 yes | no | yes | yes
4134
4135 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4136 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4137 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4138 servers.
4139
4140 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4141 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4142 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4143 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4144 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4145 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4146 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4147 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4148 picking a different server.
4149
4150 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4151 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4152 even if they have to be queued.
4153
4154 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4155 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4156
4157
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004158maxconn <conns>
4159 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 yes | yes | yes | no
4162 Arguments :
4163 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4164 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4165 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4166 closes.
4167
4168 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4169 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4170 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4171 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4172 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4173 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4174 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4175 properly tuned.
4176
4177 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4178 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4179 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4180
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004181 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4182
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004183 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4184
4185
4186mode { tcp|http|health }
4187 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4189 yes | yes | yes | yes
4190 Arguments :
4191 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4192 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4193 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4194 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4195
4196 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4197 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4198 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4199 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4200 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4201
4202 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004203 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4204 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4205 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4206 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4207 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4208 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4209 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004210
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004211 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4212 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4213 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004214
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004215 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004216 defaults http_instances
4217 mode http
4218
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004219 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004220
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004221
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004222monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004223 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4225 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004226 Arguments :
4227 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4228 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004229 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004230 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4231 backend and its backup.
4232
4233 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4234 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4235 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4236 servers in a list of backends.
4237
4238 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4239 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4240 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4241 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4242 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4243 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4244 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004245 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4246 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004247
4248 Example:
4249 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004250 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004251 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4252 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4253 monitor-uri /site_alive
4254 monitor fail if site_dead
4255
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004256 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004257
4258
4259monitor-net <source>
4260 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4262 yes | yes | yes | no
4263 Arguments :
4264 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4265 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4266 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4267 followed by a mask.
4268
4269 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4270 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004271 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004272 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4273
4274 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4275 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4276 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4277 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004278 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4279 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4280 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004281
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004282 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4283 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4284 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4285 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4286 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4287 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004288
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004289 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4290 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004291
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004292 Example :
4293 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4294 frontend www
4295 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4296
4297 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4298
4299
4300monitor-uri <uri>
4301 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4303 yes | yes | yes | no
4304 Arguments :
4305 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4306 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4307
4308 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4309 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4310 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4311 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4312 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4313 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4314 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4315 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4316
4317 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4318 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4319 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4320 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4321 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4322 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4323
4324 Example :
4325 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4326 frontend www
4327 mode http
4328 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4329
4330 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004332
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004333option abortonclose
4334no option abortonclose
4335 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4337 yes | no | yes | yes
4338 Arguments : none
4339
4340 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4341 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4342 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4343 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004344 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004345 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4346 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4347 encountered while delivering the response.
4348
4349 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4350 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4351 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4352 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4353 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4354 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004355 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004356 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004357 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004358 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4359 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4360 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4361
4362 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4363 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4364 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4365 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4366 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4367 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4368 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4369 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004370 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004371
4372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4374
4375 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4376
4377
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004378option accept-invalid-http-request
4379no option accept-invalid-http-request
4380 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4382 yes | yes | yes | no
4383 Arguments : none
4384
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004385 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004386 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4387 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4388 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4389 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4390 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4391 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4392 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004393 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4394 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4395 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4396 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4397 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004398 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004399 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4400 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4401 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004402
4403 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4404 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4405 been confirmed.
4406
4407 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4408 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004409 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4410 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004411 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4412
4413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4415
4416 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4417 stats socket.
4418
4419
4420option accept-invalid-http-response
4421no option accept-invalid-http-response
4422 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4424 yes | no | yes | yes
4425 Arguments : none
4426
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004427 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004428 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4429 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4430 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4431 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4432 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4433 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4434 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004435 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4436 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4437 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004438
4439 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4440 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4441 been confirmed.
4442
4443 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4444 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4445 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4446 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4447
4448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4450
4451 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4452 stats socket.
4453
4454
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004455option allbackups
4456no option allbackups
4457 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4459 yes | no | yes | yes
4460 Arguments : none
4461
4462 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4463 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4464 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4465 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4466 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4467 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4468 order between the backup servers anymore.
4469
4470 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4471 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4472
4473 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4474 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4475
4476
4477option checkcache
4478no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004479 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 yes | no | yes | yes
4482 Arguments : none
4483
4484 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4485 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004486 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004487 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4488 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004489 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004490
4491 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004492 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004493 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004494 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4495 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004496 to the client are :
4497 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004498 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004499 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004500 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4501 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4502 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4503 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4504 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4505 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4506 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4507 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4508 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4509 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4510 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4511
4512 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004513 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004514 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004515 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004516 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4517
4518 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4519 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004520 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004521 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4522
4523 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4524 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4525
4526
4527option clitcpka
4528no option clitcpka
4529 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4531 yes | yes | yes | no
4532 Arguments : none
4533
4534 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4535 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4536 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4537 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4538
4539 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4540 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4541 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4542 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4543
4544 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4545 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4546 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4547 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4548 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4549
4550 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4551
4552 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4553 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4554 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4555
4556 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4557 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4558
4559 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4560
4561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004562option contstats
4563 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4565 yes | yes | yes | no
4566 Arguments : none
4567
4568 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4569 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4570 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4571 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4572 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4573 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4574 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4575
4576
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004577option dontlog-normal
4578no option dontlog-normal
4579 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | yes | yes | no
4582 Arguments : none
4583
4584 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4585 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4586 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4587 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4588 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4589 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4590 logged.
4591
4592 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4593 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4594 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004596 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004597 logging.
4598
4599
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004600option dontlognull
4601no option dontlognull
4602 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4604 yes | yes | yes | no
4605 Arguments : none
4606
4607 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4608 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4609 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4610 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4611 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4612 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004613 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4614 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4615 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004616
4617 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4618 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4619 would not be logged.
4620
4621 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4622 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4623
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004624 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4625 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004626
4627
4628option forceclose
4629no option forceclose
4630 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004632 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004633 Arguments : none
4634
4635 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4636 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4637 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4638 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4639 global session times in the logs.
4640
4641 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004642 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004643 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004644
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004645 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4646 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4647 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4648
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004649 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4650 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004651
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004652 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4653 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4654
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004655 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004656
4657
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004658option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004659 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 yes | yes | yes | yes
4662 Arguments :
4663 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4664 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004665 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004666 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004667
4668 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4669 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4670 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4671 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4672 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4673 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4674 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004675 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4676 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4677 possible that the client has already brought one.
4678
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004679 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004680 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004681 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4682 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004683 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4684 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004685
4686 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4687 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4688 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4689 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4690 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4691 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4692 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4693
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004694 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4695 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4696 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4697 are under the control of the end-user.
4698
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004699 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004700 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4701 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004702 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4703 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4704 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004705
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004706 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004707 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4708 frontend www
4709 mode http
4710 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4711
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004712 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4713 backend www
4714 mode http
4715 option forwardfor header X-Client
4716
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004717 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004718 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004719
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004720
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004721option http-buffer-request
4722no option http-buffer-request
4723 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4725 yes | yes | yes | yes
4726 Arguments : none
4727
4728 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4729 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4730 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4731 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4732 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4733 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4734 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4735 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4736 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4737 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4738 default.
4739
4740 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4741
4742
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004743option http-ignore-probes
4744no option http-ignore-probes
4745 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 yes | yes | yes | no
4748 Arguments : none
4749
4750 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4751 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4752 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4753 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4754 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4755 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4756 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4757 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4758 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4759 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4760 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4761 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4762
4763 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4764 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4765 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4766 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4767 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4768 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4769 are often the only way to detect them.
4770
4771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4773
4774 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4775
4776
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004777option http-keep-alive
4778no option http-keep-alive
4779 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | yes | yes | yes
4782 Arguments : none
4783
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004784 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4785 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4786 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4787 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4788 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4789 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4790 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4791
4792 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4793 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004794 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4795 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4796 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4797 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4798 situations where this option may be useful :
4799
4800 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4801 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4802
4803 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4804 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4805
4806 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4807 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4808 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4809 request.
4810
4811 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4812 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004813 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4814 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4815 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004816
4817 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4818 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4819
4820 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4821 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4822 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4823 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4824 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4825 not set.
4826
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004827 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4828 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004829 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004830 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004831
4832 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004833 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4834 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004835
4836
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004837option http-no-delay
4838no option http-no-delay
4839 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4841 yes | yes | yes | yes
4842 Arguments : none
4843
4844 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4845 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4846 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4847 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4848 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4849 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4850 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4851 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4852 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4853 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4854 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4855 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4856 affected.
4857
4858 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4859 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4860 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4861 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4862 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4863 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4864 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4865 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4866 latency environments.
4867
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004868 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4869
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004870
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004871option http-pretend-keepalive
4872no option http-pretend-keepalive
4873 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4875 yes | yes | yes | yes
4876 Arguments : none
4877
4878 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4879 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4880 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4881 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4882 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4883 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4884 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4885 consider the response complete.
4886
4887 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4888 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4889 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4890 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4891 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4892 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4893
4894 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4895 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4896 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4897 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4898 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4899 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4900 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4901
4902 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4903 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004904 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004905 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4906 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004907
4908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4910
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004911 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4912 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004913
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004914
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004915option http-server-close
4916no option http-server-close
4917 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4919 yes | yes | yes | yes
4920 Arguments : none
4921
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004922 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4923 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4924 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4925 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4926 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4927 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4928 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4929 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4930 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4931 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4932 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4933 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4934 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4935 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4936 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4937 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004938
4939 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4940 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4941 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4942 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004943 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4944 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004945
4946 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4947 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004948 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4949 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004950 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4951 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004952
4953 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4954 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4955
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004956 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004957 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4958 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004959
4960
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004961option http-tunnel
4962no option http-tunnel
4963 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4965 yes | yes | yes | yes
4966 Arguments : none
4967
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004968 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4969 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4970 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4971 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4972 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4973 "option http-tunnel".
4974
4975 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004976 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004977 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4978 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4979 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4980 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4981 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4982 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4983 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004984
4985 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4986 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4987
4988 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4989 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4990 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4991
4992
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004993option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004994no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004995 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 yes | yes | yes | no
4998 Arguments : none
4999
5000 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5001 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5002 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5003 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5004 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5005 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5006 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5007
5008 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5009 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
5010 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
5011 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
5012 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
5013 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
5014 request along its whole life.
5015
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005016 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5017 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5018 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5019 front of an existing proxy.
5020
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005021 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5022
5023 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5024 http-server-close".
5025
5026
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005027option httpchk
5028option httpchk <uri>
5029option httpchk <method> <uri>
5030option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5031 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5033 yes | no | yes | yes
5034 Arguments :
5035 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5036 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5037 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5038 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5039 ones.
5040
5041 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5042 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5043 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5044
5045 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5046 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5047 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5048 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5049 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5050
5051 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5052 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5053 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5054 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5055 the lack of any response.
5056
5057 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5058
5059 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5060 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5061 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5062
5063 Examples :
5064 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5065 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5066 backend https_relay
5067 mode tcp
5068 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5069 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5070
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005071 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5072 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5073 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005074
5075
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005076option httpclose
5077no option httpclose
5078 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5080 yes | yes | yes | yes
5081 Arguments : none
5082
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005083 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5084 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5085 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5086 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005087 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005088 "option http-tunnel".
5089
5090 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5091 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5092 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5093 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5094 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5095 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5096 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5097 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005098
5099 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005100 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005101 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5102 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5103 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5104 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5105 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005106
5107 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5108 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005109 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5110 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005111 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5112 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005113
5114 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5115 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5116
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005117 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5118 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005119
5120
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005121option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005122 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5124 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005125 Arguments :
5126 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5127 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5128 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5129 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5130 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005131
5132 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5133 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5134 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5135 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5136 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5137 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5138 ports.
5139
5140 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5141
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005142 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5143 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005145 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005146
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005147
5148option http_proxy
5149no option http_proxy
5150 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 yes | yes | yes | yes
5153 Arguments : none
5154
5155 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5156 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5157 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5158 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5159 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5160
5161 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5162 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5163 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5164 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005165 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005166 be analyzed.
5167
5168 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5169 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5170
5171 Example :
5172 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5173 backend direct_forward
5174 option httpclose
5175 option http_proxy
5176
5177 See also : "option httpclose"
5178
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005179
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005180option independent-streams
5181no option independent-streams
5182 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 yes | yes | yes | yes
5185 Arguments : none
5186
5187 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5188 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5189 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5190 receive data or not.
5191
5192 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5193 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5194 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5195 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5196 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5197 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5198 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5199 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5200 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5201 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5202 socket buffers.
5203
5204 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5205 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5206 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5207 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5208 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5209
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005210 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005211 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5212 deprecated.
5213
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005214 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005215
5216
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005217option ldap-check
5218 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5220 yes | no | yes | yes
5221 Arguments : none
5222
5223 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5224 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5225 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5226 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5227
5228 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5229 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5230
5231 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5232 configure it.
5233
5234 Example :
5235 option ldap-check
5236
5237 See also : "option httpchk"
5238
5239
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005240option external-check
5241 Use external processes for server health checks
5242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5243 yes | no | yes | yes
5244
5245 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5246 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5247 command".
5248
5249 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5250
5251 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5252
5253
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005254option log-health-checks
5255no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005256 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5258 yes | no | yes | yes
5259 Arguments : none
5260
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005261 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5262 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5263 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005264
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005265 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5266 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5267 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5268 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5269 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5270
5271 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5272 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005273
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005274 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5275 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5276 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005277
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005278
5279option log-separate-errors
5280no option log-separate-errors
5281 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | yes | yes | no
5284 Arguments : none
5285
5286 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5287 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5288 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5289 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5290 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5291 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5292 provides very important information.
5293
5294 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5295 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5296 error logs.
5297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005298 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005299 logging.
5300
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005301
5302option logasap
5303no option logasap
5304 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5306 yes | yes | yes | no
5307 Arguments : none
5308
5309 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5310 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5311 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5312 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5313 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5314 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5315 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005316 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005317 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5318 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5319
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005320 Examples :
5321 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5322 mode http
5323 option httplog
5324 option logasap
5325 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5326
5327 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5328 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5329 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5330 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005332 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005333 logging.
5334
5335
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005336option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005337 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5339 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005340 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005341 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5342 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005343 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005344
5345 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5346 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5347 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5348 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5349 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5350 in the MySQL table, like this :
5351
5352 USE mysql;
5353 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5354 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5355
5356 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5357 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5358 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5359 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5360 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5361 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5362 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5363 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5364 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5365
5366 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5367 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005368
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005369 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005370
5371 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5372 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5373 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5374 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5375 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5376 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5377
5378 See also: "option httpchk"
5379
5380
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005381option nolinger
5382no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005383 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005384 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5385 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005386 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005387
5388 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5389 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5390 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5391 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5392 connections.
5393
5394 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5395 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5396 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5397 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5398 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5399 this too.
5400
5401 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5402 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5403 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5404
5405 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5406 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5407 for servers.
5408
5409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5411
5412
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005413option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5414 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5416 yes | yes | yes | yes
5417 Arguments :
5418 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5419 matching <network>
5420 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5421 header name.
5422
5423 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5424 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5425 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5426 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5427 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5428 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5429 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5430 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5431 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5432 possible that the client has already brought one.
5433
5434 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5435 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5436 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5437 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5438 header and requires different one.
5439
5440 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5441 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5442 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5443 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5444 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5445 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5446 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5447
5448 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5449 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5450 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5451 both are defined.
5452
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005453 Examples :
5454 # Original Destination address
5455 frontend www
5456 mode http
5457 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5458
5459 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5460 backend www
5461 mode http
5462 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5463
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005464 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5465 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005466
5467
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005468option persist
5469no option persist
5470 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5472 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005473 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005474
5475 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5476 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5477 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5478 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5479 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5480 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5481 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5482 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5483 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5484 redirected to another valid server.
5485
5486 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5487 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5488
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005489 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005490
5491
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005492option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5493 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5495 yes | no | yes | yes
5496 Arguments :
5497 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5498 PostgreSQL server.
5499
5500 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5501 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5502 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5503 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5504
5505 See also: "option httpchk"
5506
5507
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005508option prefer-last-server
5509no option prefer-last-server
5510 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5511 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5512 yes | no | yes | yes
5513 Arguments : none
5514
5515 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5516 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5517 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5518 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5519 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5520 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5521 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5522 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5523 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005524 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5525 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5526 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5527 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5528 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5529 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5530 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005531
5532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5534
5535 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5536
5537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005538option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005539option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005540no option redispatch
5541 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5542 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5543 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005544 Arguments :
5545 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5546 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5547 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5548 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5549 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5550 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5551 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5552 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5553 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005555
5556 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5557 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5558 be able to access the service anymore.
5559
5560 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5561 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5562
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005563 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005564 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5565 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005567 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5568 "redisp" keywords.
5569
5570 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5571 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5572
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005573 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005574
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005575
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005576option redis-check
5577 Use redis health checks for server testing
5578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5579 yes | no | yes | yes
5580 Arguments : none
5581
5582 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5583 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5584 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5585 find the "+PONG" response message.
5586
5587 Example :
5588 option redis-check
5589
5590 See also : "option httpchk"
5591
5592
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005593option smtpchk
5594option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5595 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5597 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005598 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005599 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5600 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5601 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5602
5603 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5604 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5605 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5606
5607 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5608 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5609 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5610 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5611 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5612 dead server.
5613
5614 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5615 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5616 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5617 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5618
5619 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5620 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5621 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5622 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5623 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5624
5625 Example :
5626 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5627
5628 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005631option socket-stats
5632no option socket-stats
5633
5634 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5636 yes | yes | yes | no
5637
5638 Arguments : none
5639
5640
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005641option splice-auto
5642no option splice-auto
5643 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 yes | yes | yes | yes
5646 Arguments : none
5647
5648 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5649 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5650 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5651 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005652 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005653 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5654 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5655 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5656 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5657
5658 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5659 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5660 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5661 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5662 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5663 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5664 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5665 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5666 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5667 keyword.
5668
5669 Example :
5670 option splice-auto
5671
5672 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5673 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5674
5675 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5676 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5677
5678
5679option splice-request
5680no option splice-request
5681 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5683 yes | yes | yes | yes
5684 Arguments : none
5685
5686 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005687 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005688 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5689 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5690 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5691 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5692
5693 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5694
5695 Example :
5696 option splice-request
5697
5698 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5699 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5700
5701 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5702 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5703
5704
5705option splice-response
5706no option splice-response
5707 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5709 yes | yes | yes | yes
5710 Arguments : none
5711
5712 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005713 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005714 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5715 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5716 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5717 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5718
5719 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5720
5721 Example :
5722 option splice-response
5723
5724 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5725 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5726
5727 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5728 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5729
5730
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005731option srvtcpka
5732no option srvtcpka
5733 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5735 yes | no | yes | yes
5736 Arguments : none
5737
5738 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5739 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5740 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5741 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5742
5743 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5744 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5745 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5746 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5747
5748 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5749 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5750 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5751 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5752 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5753
5754 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5755
5756 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5757 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5758 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5759
5760 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5761 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5762
5763 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5764
5765
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005766option ssl-hello-chk
5767 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5769 yes | no | yes | yes
5770 Arguments : none
5771
5772 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5773 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5774 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5775 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5776 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5777 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5778 hello message.
5779
5780 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5781 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5782 messages, which is appreciable.
5783
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005784 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5785 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5786 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005787
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005788 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5789
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005790
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005791option tcp-check
5792 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5794 yes | no | yes | yes
5795
5796 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5797 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5798
5799 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5800 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5801 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5802
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005803 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005804 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5805 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5806 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5807 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5808 only.
5809
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005810 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005811 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5812 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5813 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5814 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5815
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005816 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005817 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5818 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005819 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005820 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5821 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5822 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5823 the respective protocols.
5824 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5825 analysed.
5826
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005827 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5828 script.
5829
5830 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5831 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5832 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5833 The "comment" is of course optional.
5834
5835
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005836 Examples :
5837 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5838 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005839 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005840
5841 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5842 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005843 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005844
5845 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5846 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005847 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005848 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005849 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005850 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005851 tcp-check expect +PONGe
5852 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005853 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5854 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005855 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005856 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5857 tcp-check expect string +OK
5858
5859 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5860 (send many headers before analyzing)
5861 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005862 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005863 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5864 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5865 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5866 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005867 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005868
5869
5870 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5871
5872
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005873option tcp-smart-accept
5874no option tcp-smart-accept
5875 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5877 yes | yes | yes | no
5878 Arguments : none
5879
5880 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5881 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5882 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5883 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5884 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5885 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5886
5887 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5888 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5889 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5890 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5891
5892 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5893 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5894 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5895 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5896
5897 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5898 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5899 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5900
5901 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5902 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5903 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5904
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005905 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5906
5907
5908option tcp-smart-connect
5909no option tcp-smart-connect
5910 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5912 yes | no | yes | yes
5913 Arguments : none
5914
5915 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5916 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5917 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5918 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5919 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5920
5921 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5922 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5923 complex.
5924
5925 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5926 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5927 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5928
5929 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5930 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5931
5932 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5933
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005934
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005935option tcpka
5936 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5938 yes | yes | yes | yes
5939 Arguments : none
5940
5941 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5942 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5943 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5944 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5945
5946 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5947 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5948 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5949 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5950
5951 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5952 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5953 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5954 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5955 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5956
5957 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5958
5959 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5960 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5961 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5962 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5963 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5964 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5965 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5966 backends.
5967
5968 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5969
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005970
5971option tcplog
5972 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5974 yes | yes | yes | yes
5975 Arguments : none
5976
5977 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5978 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5979 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5980 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5981 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5982 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5983 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5984 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5985
5986 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005988 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005989
5990
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005991option transparent
5992no option transparent
5993 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005995 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005996 Arguments : none
5997
5998 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5999 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6000 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6001 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6002 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6003 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6004 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6005 appropriate server.
6006
6007 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6008 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6009
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006010 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006011 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006012
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006013
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006014external-check command <command>
6015 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6017 yes | no | yes | yes
6018
6019 Arguments :
6020 <command> is the external command to run
6021
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006022 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6023
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006024 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006025
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006026 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6027 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6028 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6029 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6030 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6031 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006032
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006033 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6034
6035 Environment variables :
6036 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6037 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6038
6039 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6040
6041 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6042
6043 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6044 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6045 for a UNIX socket).
6046
6047 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6048
6049 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6050
6051 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6052
6053 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6054
6055 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6056
6057 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6058 socket).
6059
6060 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6061 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6062
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006063 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6064 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6065 failed.
6066
6067 Example :
6068 external-check command /bin/true
6069
6070 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6071
6072
6073external-check path <path>
6074 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6076 yes | no | yes | yes
6077
6078 Arguments :
6079 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6080
6081 The default path is "".
6082
6083 Example :
6084 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6085
6086 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6087 "external-check command"
6088
6089
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006090persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006091persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006092 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6094 yes | no | yes | yes
6095 Arguments :
6096 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006097 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6098 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006099
6100 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6101 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6102 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6103 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6104 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6105 forwarded to this server.
6106
6107 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6108 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6109 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006110 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006111 a single "listen" section.
6112
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006113 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6114 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6115 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6116
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006117 Example :
6118 listen tse-farm
6119 bind :3389
6120 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6121 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6122 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6123 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6124 persist rdp-cookie
6125 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006126 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006127 balance rdp-cookie
6128 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6129 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6130
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006131 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6132 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006133
6134
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006135rate-limit sessions <rate>
6136 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6138 yes | yes | yes | no
6139 Arguments :
6140 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6141 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6142
6143 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6144 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6145 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6146 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6147 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6148 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6149
6150 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6151 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6152 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6153 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6154
6155 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6156 listen smtp
6157 mode tcp
6158 bind :25
6159 rate-limit sessions 10
6160 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6161
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006162 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6163 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6164 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006165
6166 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6167
6168
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006169redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6170redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6171redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006172 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6174 no | yes | yes | yes
6175
6176 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006177 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006178
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006179 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006180 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006181 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6182 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6183 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006184
6185 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6186 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6187 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6188 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6189 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006190 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6191 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6192 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6193 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006194
6195 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6196 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6197 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6198 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6199 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6200 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006201 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006202 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006203 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6204 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6205 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006206
6207 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006208 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6209 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6210 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
6211 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
6212 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6213 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6214 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6215 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006216
6217 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6218 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6219
6220 - "drop-query"
6221 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6222 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6223 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6224 with a location-type redirect.
6225
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006226 - "append-slash"
6227 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6228 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6229 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6230 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6231
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006232 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6233 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6234 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6235 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6236 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6237 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6238 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6239
6240 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6241 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6242 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6243 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6244 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6245 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6246 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006247
6248 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6249 acl clear dst_port 80
6250 acl secure dst_port 8080
6251 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006252 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006253 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006254 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6255
6256 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006257 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6258 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6259 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006260 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006261
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006262 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6263 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6264 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6265
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006266 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006267 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006268
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006269 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6270 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6271 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006273 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006274
6275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006276redisp (deprecated)
6277redispatch (deprecated)
6278 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6279 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6280 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006281 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006282
6283 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6284 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6285 be able to access the service anymore.
6286
6287 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6288 redistribute them to a working server.
6289
6290 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6291 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6292 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006294 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6295 "option redispatch" instead.
6296
6297 See also : "option redispatch"
6298
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006299
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006300reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006301 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6303 no | yes | yes | yes
6304 Arguments :
6305 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6306 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006307 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006308
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006309 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6310 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6311
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006312 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6313 the last header of an HTTP request.
6314
6315 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6316 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6317 responses.
6318
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006319 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6320 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6321 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6322
6323 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6324 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006325
6326
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006327reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6328reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006329 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6331 no | yes | yes | yes
6332 Arguments :
6333 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6334 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6335 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6336 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6337 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6338 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6339 ignores case.
6340
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006341 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6342 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6343
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006344 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6345 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6346 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6347 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006348 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006349
6350 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6351 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6352
6353 Example :
6354 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6355 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6356 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6357
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006358 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6359 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006360
6361
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006362reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6363reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006364 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6366 no | yes | yes | yes
6367 Arguments :
6368 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6369 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6370 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6371 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6372 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6373 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6374
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006375 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6376 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6377
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006378 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6379 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6380 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6381 next servers.
6382
6383 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6384 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6385 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6386
6387 Example :
6388 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6389 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6390 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6391
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006392 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6393 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006394
6395
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006396reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6397reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006398 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6400 no | yes | yes | yes
6401 Arguments :
6402 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6403 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6404 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6405 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6406 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6407 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6408 case.
6409
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006410 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6411 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6412
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006413 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6414 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6415 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6416 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006417 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006418
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006419 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006420 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006421 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006422
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006423 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6424 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6425
6426 Example :
6427 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6428 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6429 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6430
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006431 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6432 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006433
6434
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006435reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6436reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006437 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6439 no | yes | yes | yes
6440 Arguments :
6441 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6442 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6443 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6444 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6445 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6446 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6447 case.
6448
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006449 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6450 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6451
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006452 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6453 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6454 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6455 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6456
6457 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6458 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6459
6460 Example :
6461 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6462 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6463 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6464 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6465
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006466 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6467 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006468
6469
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006470reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6471reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006472 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6474 no | yes | yes | yes
6475 Arguments :
6476 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6477 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6478 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6479 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6480 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6481 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6482
6483 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6484 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6485 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6486 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006487 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006488
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006489 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6490 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6491
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006492 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6493 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6494 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6495
6496 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6497 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6498 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6499 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6500 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6501
6502 Example :
6503 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006504 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006505 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6506 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6507
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006508 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6509 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006510
6511
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006512reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6513reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006514 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6516 no | yes | yes | yes
6517 Arguments :
6518 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6519 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6520 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6521 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6522 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6523 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6524 ignores case.
6525
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006526 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6527 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6528
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006529 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6530 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006531 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6532 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6533 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006534 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6535 not set.
6536
6537 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6538 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6539 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6540 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6541 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6542
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006543 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006544 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6545 # block all others.
6546 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6547 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6548
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006549 # block bad guys
6550 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6551 reqitarpit . if badguys
6552
6553 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6554 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006555
6556
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006557retries <value>
6558 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6559 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6560 yes | no | yes | yes
6561 Arguments :
6562 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6563 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6564 default value is 3.
6565
6566 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6567 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6568 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6569
6570 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006571 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6572 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006573
6574 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6575 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6576
6577 See also : "option redispatch"
6578
6579
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006580rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006581 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6583 no | yes | yes | yes
6584 Arguments :
6585 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6586 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006587 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006588
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006589 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6590 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6591
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006592 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6593 the last header of an HTTP response.
6594
6595 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6596 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6597 responses.
6598
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006599 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6600 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006601
6602
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006603rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6604rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006605 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6607 no | yes | yes | yes
6608 Arguments :
6609 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6610 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6611 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6612 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6613 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6614 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6615 ignores case.
6616
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006617 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6618 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6619
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006620 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6621 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006622 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006623 client.
6624
6625 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6626 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6627 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6628
6629 Example :
6630 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006631 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006632
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006633 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6634 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006635
6636
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006637rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6638rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006639 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6641 no | yes | yes | yes
6642 Arguments :
6643 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6644 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6645 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6646 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6647 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6648 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6649 ignores case.
6650
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006651 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6652 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6653
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006654 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6655 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6656 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6657 case-sensitive.
6658
6659 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006660 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6661 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6662 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006663
6664 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6665 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6666
6667 Example :
6668 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6669 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6670
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006671 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6672 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006673
6674
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006675rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6676rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006677 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6679 no | yes | yes | yes
6680 Arguments :
6681 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6682 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6683 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6684 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6685 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6686 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6687 ignores case.
6688
6689 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6690 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6691 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6692 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006693 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006694
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006695 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6696 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6697
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006698 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6699 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6700 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6701
6702 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6703 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6704 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6705 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6706 are not case-sensitive.
6707
6708 Example :
6709 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6710 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6711
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006712 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6713 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006714
6715
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006716server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006717 Declare a server in a backend
6718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6719 no | no | yes | yes
6720 Arguments :
6721 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006722 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006723 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006724
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006725 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6726 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6727 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6728 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006729 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6730 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6731 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6732 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6733 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006734 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6735 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6736 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6737 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6738 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6739 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6740 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006741 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006742 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6743 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6744 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006745
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006746 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006747 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6748 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6749 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6750 adding this value to the client's port.
6751
6752 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6753 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006754 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006755
6756 Examples :
6757 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6758 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006759 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006760 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6761 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6762 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006763
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006764 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6765 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006766
6767
6768source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006769source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006770source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006771 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6773 yes | no | yes | yes
6774 Arguments :
6775 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6776 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006777
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006778 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006779 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6780 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6781 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6782 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6783 supported prefixes are :
6784 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6785 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6786 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006787 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006788 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6789 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006790
6791 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6792 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006793 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6794 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6795 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006796
6797 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6798 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6799 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6800 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6801 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6802 <addr>.
6803
6804 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6805 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6806 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6807 port.
6808
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006809 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6810 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6811 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6812 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006813 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006814 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6815 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6816 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6817 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6818 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6819 HTTP header.
6820
6821 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6822 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006823 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006824 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6825 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6826 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6827 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6828 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6829 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6830 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6831
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006832 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6833 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6834 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6835 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6836 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6837 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6838
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006839 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6840 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6841 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6842 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6843
6844 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6845 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6846 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6847 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6848 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6849 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6850
6851 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6852 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6853 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6854 there are two methods :
6855
6856 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6857 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6858 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6859 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6860 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6861 of the client ranges may be used.
6862
6863 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6864 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6865 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6866 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6867 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6868 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6869 same session.
6870
6871 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6872 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6873 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6874 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6875 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6876 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6877
6878 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6879 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6880 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006881 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006882
6883 Examples :
6884 backend private
6885 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6886 source 192.168.1.200
6887
6888 backend transparent_ssl1
6889 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6890 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6891
6892 backend transparent_ssl2
6893 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6894 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6895 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6896
6897 backend transparent_ssl3
6898 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6899 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6900 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6901
6902 backend transparent_smtp
6903 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6904 # with Tproxy version 4.
6905 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6906
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006907 backend transparent_http
6908 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6909 # proxy.
6910 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006912 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006913 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6914
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006915
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006916srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6917 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6919 yes | no | yes | yes
6920 Arguments :
6921 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6922 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6923 as explained at the top of this document.
6924
6925 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6926 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6927 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6928 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6929 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6930 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6931 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6932
6933 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6934 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6935 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6936 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6937 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006938 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006939 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006940 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006941
6942 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6943 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6944 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6945 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6946 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6947 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6948
6949 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6950 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6951
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006952 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6953 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006954
6955
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006956stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6957 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006959 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006960
6961 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6962 matched.
6963
6964 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6965 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6966
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006967 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6968 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6969 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6970
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006971 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6972 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6973 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6974 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006975
6976 Example :
6977 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6978 backend stats_localhost
6979 stats enable
6980 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6981
6982 Example :
6983 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6984 backend stats_auth
6985 stats enable
6986 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6987 stats admin if TRUE
6988
6989 Example :
6990 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6991 userlist stats-auth
6992 group admin users admin
6993 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6994 group readonly users haproxy
6995 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6996
6997 backend stats_auth
6998 stats enable
6999 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7000 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7001 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7002 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7003
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007004 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7005 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7006 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007007
7008
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007009stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7010 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007012 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007013 Arguments :
7014 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7015
7016 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7017
7018 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7019 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7020 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7021 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7022 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7023 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7024
7025 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7026 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7027 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007028 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007029
7030 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7031 report using "stats scope".
7032
7033 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7034 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7035 unobvious parameters.
7036
7037 Example :
7038 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7039 backend public_www
7040 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7041 stats enable
7042 stats hide-version
7043 stats scope .
7044 stats uri /admin?stats
7045 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7046 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7047 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7048
7049 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7050 backend private_monitoring
7051 stats enable
7052 stats uri /admin?stats
7053 stats refresh 5s
7054
7055 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7056
7057
7058stats enable
7059 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007061 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007062 Arguments : none
7063
7064 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7065 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7066 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7067 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7068 - stats auth : no authentication
7069 - stats scope : no restriction
7070
7071 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7072 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7073 unobvious parameters.
7074
7075 Example :
7076 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7077 backend public_www
7078 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7079 stats enable
7080 stats hide-version
7081 stats scope .
7082 stats uri /admin?stats
7083 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7084 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7085 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7086
7087 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7088 backend private_monitoring
7089 stats enable
7090 stats uri /admin?stats
7091 stats refresh 5s
7092
7093 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7094
7095
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007096stats hide-version
7097 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007099 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007100 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007101
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007102 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7103 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7104 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7105 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7106 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7107 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007109 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7110 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7111 unobvious parameters.
7112
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007113 Example :
7114 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7115 backend public_www
7116 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007117 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007118 stats hide-version
7119 stats scope .
7120 stats uri /admin?stats
7121 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7122 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7123 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007124
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007125 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7126 backend private_monitoring
7127 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007128 stats uri /admin?stats
7129 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007131 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007132
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007133
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007134stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7135 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7136 Access control for statistics
7137
7138 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7139 no | no | yes | yes
7140
7141 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7142 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7143 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7144 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7145 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7146 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7147
7148 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7149 instance.
7150
7151 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7152 about ACL usage.
7153
7154
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007155stats realm <realm>
7156 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007158 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007159 Arguments :
7160 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7161 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7162 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7163
7164 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7165 using a backslash ('\').
7166
7167 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7168 only related to authentication.
7169
7170 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7171 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7172 unobvious parameters.
7173
7174 Example :
7175 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7176 backend public_www
7177 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7178 stats enable
7179 stats hide-version
7180 stats scope .
7181 stats uri /admin?stats
7182 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7183 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7184 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7185
7186 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7187 backend private_monitoring
7188 stats enable
7189 stats uri /admin?stats
7190 stats refresh 5s
7191
7192 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7193
7194
7195stats refresh <delay>
7196 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007198 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007199 Arguments :
7200 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7201 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7202 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7203 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7204 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7205 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7206
7207 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7208 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7209 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7210 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7211
7212 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7213 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7214 unobvious parameters.
7215
7216 Example :
7217 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7218 backend public_www
7219 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7220 stats enable
7221 stats hide-version
7222 stats scope .
7223 stats uri /admin?stats
7224 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7225 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7226 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7227
7228 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7229 backend private_monitoring
7230 stats enable
7231 stats uri /admin?stats
7232 stats refresh 5s
7233
7234 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7235
7236
7237stats scope { <name> | "." }
7238 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007240 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007241 Arguments :
7242 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7243 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7244 section in which the statement appears.
7245
7246 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7247 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7248 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7249 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7250 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7251 exists.
7252
7253 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7254 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7255 unobvious parameters.
7256
7257 Example :
7258 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7259 backend public_www
7260 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7261 stats enable
7262 stats hide-version
7263 stats scope .
7264 stats uri /admin?stats
7265 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7266 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7267 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7268
7269 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7270 backend private_monitoring
7271 stats enable
7272 stats uri /admin?stats
7273 stats refresh 5s
7274
7275 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7276
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007277
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007278stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007279 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007281 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007282
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007283 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007284 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7285
7286 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7287 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7288
7289 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7290 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007291 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007292
7293 Example :
7294 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7295 backend private_monitoring
7296 stats enable
7297 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7298 stats uri /admin?stats
7299 stats refresh 5s
7300
7301 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7302 global section.
7303
7304
7305stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007306 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7308 yes | yes | yes | yes
7309 Arguments : none
7310
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007311 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007312 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7313 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7314 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7315 - IP (socket, server)
7316 - cookie (backend, server)
7317
7318 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7319 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007320 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007321
7322 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7323
7324
7325stats show-node [ <name> ]
7326 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007328 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007329 Arguments:
7330 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7331 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7332
7333 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7334 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007335 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007336
7337 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7338 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7339 unobvious parameters.
7340
7341 Example:
7342 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7343 backend private_monitoring
7344 stats enable
7345 stats show-node Europe-1
7346 stats uri /admin?stats
7347 stats refresh 5s
7348
7349 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7350 section.
7351
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007352
7353stats uri <prefix>
7354 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007356 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007357 Arguments :
7358 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7359 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7360 query string.
7361
7362 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7363 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7364 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7365 possible to reach it in the application.
7366
7367 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007368 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007369 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7370 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7371 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7372 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7373
7374 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7375 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7376 an address or a port to statistics only.
7377
7378 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7379 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7380 unobvious parameters.
7381
7382 Example :
7383 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7384 backend public_www
7385 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7386 stats enable
7387 stats hide-version
7388 stats scope .
7389 stats uri /admin?stats
7390 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7391 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7392 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7393
7394 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7395 backend private_monitoring
7396 stats enable
7397 stats uri /admin?stats
7398 stats refresh 5s
7399
7400 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7401
7402
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007403stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7404 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007406 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007407
7408 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007409 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007410 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7411 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7412 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7413
7414 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7415 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7416 the "stick-table" statement.
7417
7418 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7419 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7420 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7421 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7422 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7423
7424 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7425 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7426 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7427 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7428 transformation rules.
7429
7430 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7431 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7432 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7433 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7434 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7435 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7436 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7437
7438 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7439 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7440 ACL based conditions.
7441
7442 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7443 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7444 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7445 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7446
7447 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7448 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7449 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7450 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7451
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007452 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7453 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7454 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7455
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007456 Example :
7457 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7458 # last 30 minutes
7459 backend pop
7460 mode tcp
7461 balance roundrobin
7462 stick store-request src
7463 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7464 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7465 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7466
7467 backend smtp
7468 mode tcp
7469 balance roundrobin
7470 stick match src table pop
7471 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7472 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7473
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007474 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007475 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007476
7477
7478stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7479 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7481 no | no | yes | yes
7482
7483 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7484 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7485 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7486 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7487
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007488 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7489 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7490 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7491
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007492 Examples :
7493 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007494 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007495
7496 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7497 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7498 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7499
7500
7501 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7502 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7503 backend http
7504 mode http
7505 balance roundrobin
7506 stick on src table https
7507 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7508 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7509 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7510
7511 backend https
7512 mode tcp
7513 balance roundrobin
7514 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7515 stick on src
7516 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7517 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7518
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007519 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007520
7521
7522stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7523 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7525 no | no | yes | yes
7526
7527 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007528 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007529 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7530 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7531 server is selected.
7532
7533 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7534 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7535 the "stick-table" statement.
7536
7537 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7538 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7539 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7540 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7541 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7542 address.
7543
7544 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7545 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7546 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7547 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7548 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7549 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7550 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7551 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7552 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7553 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7554
7555 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7556 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7557 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7558 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7559 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7560 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7561 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7562
7563 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7564 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7565 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7566 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7567
7568 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7569 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7570 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7571 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7572 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7573 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007574 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7575 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7576 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7577 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7578 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7579 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007580
7581 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7582 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7583 the request.
7584
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007585 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7586 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7587 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7588
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007589 Example :
7590 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7591 # last 30 minutes
7592 backend pop
7593 mode tcp
7594 balance roundrobin
7595 stick store-request src
7596 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7597 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7598 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7599
7600 backend smtp
7601 mode tcp
7602 balance roundrobin
7603 stick match src table pop
7604 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7605 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7606
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007607 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007608 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007609
7610
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007611stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007612 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7613 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007614 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007616 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007617
7618 Arguments :
7619 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7620 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7621 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7622 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7623
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007624 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7625 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7626 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7627 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7628
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007629 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7630 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7631 instance.
7632
7633 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7634 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7635 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7636 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7637 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7638 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007639 to 32 characters.
7640
7641 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7642 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7643 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007644 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007645 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7646 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007647
7648 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007649 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7650 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007651 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7652 increase.
7653
7654 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007655 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7656 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7657 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007658
7659 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7660 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7661 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7662 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7663 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7664 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7665 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7666 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7667 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7668 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7669 parameter (see below).
7670
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007671 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7672 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7673 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7674 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7675 soft restart.
7676
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007677 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7678 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007679
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007680 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7681 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7682 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7683 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7684 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007685 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007686 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7687 if not expiration delay is specified.
7688
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007689 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7690 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7691 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7692 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007693 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7694 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7695 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7696 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7697 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7698 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7699 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7700 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7701 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7702 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7703 types and their arguments.
7704
7705 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7706 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7707 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7708 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7709
7710 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7711 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7712 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7713 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7714
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007715 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7716 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7717 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7718 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7719 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7720 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7721
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007722 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7723 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7724 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7725 they were received.
7726
7727 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7728 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7729 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7730 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7731 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7732
7733 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7734 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7735 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7736 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7737 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7738
7739 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7740 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7741 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7742
7743 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7744 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7745 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7746 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7747 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7748
7749 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7750 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7751 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7752 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7753 the client side.
7754
7755 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7756 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7757 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7758 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7759 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7760 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7761 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7762
7763 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7764 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7765 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7766 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7767 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7768 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7769 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7770
7771 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7772 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7773 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7774 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7775 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7776 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7777
7778 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7779 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7780 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7781 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7782
7783 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7784 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7785 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7786 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7787 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7788 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7789 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7790 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7791 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7792 recommended for better fairness.
7793
7794 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7795 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7796 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7797 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7798
7799 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7800 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7801 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7802 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7803 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7804 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7805 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7806 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7807 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7808 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007809
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007810 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7811 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007812 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7813 reference it.
7814
7815 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7816 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7817 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7818 as an exclusive stickiness.
7819
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007820 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7821 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7822 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7823 something that can be ignored.
7824
7825 Example:
7826 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7827 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7828 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7829 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7830
7831 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007832 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007833
7834
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007835stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7836 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7838 no | no | yes | yes
7839
7840 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007841 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007842 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7843 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7844 server is selected.
7845
7846 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7847 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7848 the "stick-table" statement.
7849
7850 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7851 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7852 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7853 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7854
7855 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7856 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7857 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7858 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7859 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7860 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007861 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007862 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7863 rules.
7864
7865 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7866 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7867 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7868 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7869 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7870 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7871 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7872
7873 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7874 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7875 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7876 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7877
7878 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7879 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7880 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7881 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7882 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7883 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007884 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7885 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7886 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7887 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7888 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7889 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7890 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7891 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7892 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007893
7894 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7895
7896 Example :
7897 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7898 backend https
7899 mode tcp
7900 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007901 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007902 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007903
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007904 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7905 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7906
7907 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7908 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7909 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7910
7911 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7912 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007913
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007914 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7915 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7916 # at offset 44.
7917
7918 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7919 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7920
7921 # Learn on response if server hello.
7922 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007923
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007924 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7925 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7926
7927 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7928 extraction.
7929
7930
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007931tcp-check connect [params*]
7932 Opens a new connection
7933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7934 no | no | yes | yes
7935
7936 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7937 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7938 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7939
7940 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7941 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7942 of the sequence.
7943
7944 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7945 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7946 do.
7947
7948 Parameters :
7949 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7950 use the TCP connection.
7951
7952 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7953 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7954 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7955
7956 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7957
7958 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7959
7960 Examples:
7961 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7962 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7963 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7964 option tcp-check
7965 tcp-check connect
7966 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7967 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7968 tcp-check send \r\n
7969 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7970 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7971 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7972 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7973 tcp-check send \r\n
7974 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7975 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7976
7977 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7978 option tcp-check
7979 tcp-check connect port 110
7980 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7981 tcp-check connect port 143
7982 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7983 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7984
7985 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7986
7987
7988tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7989 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7991 no | no | yes | yes
7992
7993 Arguments :
7994 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7995 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7996 binary.
7997 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7998 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7999 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8000
8001 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8002 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8003 with the usual backslash ('\').
8004 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8005 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8006 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8007 used upper or lower case.
8008
8009
8010 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8011
8012 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8013 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8014 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8015 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8016 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8017 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8018 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8019 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8020
8021 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8022 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8023 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8024 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8025 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8026 expression.
8027
8028 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8029 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8030 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8031 this exact hexadecimal string.
8032 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8033
8034 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8035 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8036 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8037 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8038 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8039 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8040 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8041 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8042 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8043 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8044 the null character.
8045
8046 Examples :
8047 # perform a POP check
8048 option tcp-check
8049 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8050
8051 # perform an IMAP check
8052 option tcp-check
8053 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8054
8055 # look for the redis master server
8056 option tcp-check
8057 tcp-check send PING\r\n
8058 tcp-check expect +PONG
8059 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8060 tcp-check expect string role:master
8061 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8062 tcp-check expect string +OK
8063
8064
8065 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8066 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8067
8068
8069tcp-check send <data>
8070 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8071 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8072 no | no | yes | yes
8073
8074 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8075 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8076
8077 Examples :
8078 # look for the redis master server
8079 option tcp-check
8080 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8081 tcp-check expect string role:master
8082
8083 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8084 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8085
8086
8087tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8088 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8089 tcp health check
8090 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8091 no | no | yes | yes
8092
8093 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8094 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8095 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8096 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8097 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8098 hexadecimal string.
8099 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8100
8101 Examples :
8102 # redis check in binary
8103 option tcp-check
8104 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8105 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8106
8107
8108 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8109 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8110
8111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008112tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8113 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8115 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008116 Arguments :
8117 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008118 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
8119 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008120
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008121 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008122
8123 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8124 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008125 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8126 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8127 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8128 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8129 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8130 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008131
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008132 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8133 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8134 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8135 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008136
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008137 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008138 - accept :
8139 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8140 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8141 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008142
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008143 - reject :
8144 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8145 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8146 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8147 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8148 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8149 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8150 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8151 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8152 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8153 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8154 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8155 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008156
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008157 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8158 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8159 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8160 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8161 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8162 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8163 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8164 hosts.
8165
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008166 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8167 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8168 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8169 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8170 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8171 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8172 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8173 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8174 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008175 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8176 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008177
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008178 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008179 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008180 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008181 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008182 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8183 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008184 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008185 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8186 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8187 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8188 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8189 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008191 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008192 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008193 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008194 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8195 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8196 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8197 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008199 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8200 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8201 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8202 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008204 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8205 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8206 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8207 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8208 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008209 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8210 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8211 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8212 layer7 information is extracted.
8213
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008214 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8215 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8216 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8217 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8218 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008219
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008220 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8221 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8222 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008223
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008224 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8225 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8226 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008228 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008229 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008230 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008231
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008232 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8233 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8234 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008236 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008237 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8238 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008239
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008240 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8241
8242 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8243
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008244 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008246 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008247
8248
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008249tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8250 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008252 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008253 Arguments :
8254 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008255 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008256 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
8257 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008259 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008261 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8262 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8263 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8264 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8265 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008267 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8268 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8269 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8270 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008271 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8272 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8273 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8274 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8275 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8276 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008277 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008278 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008280 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8281 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8282 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8283 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008284
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008285 Four types of actions are supported :
8286 - accept : the request is accepted
8287 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8288 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008289 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008290 - lua <function>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008291 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008292
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008293 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8294 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008295
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008296 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8297 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8298 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8299 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8300 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8301 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008303 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008304 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8305 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008306
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008307 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008308 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8309 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8310 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8311 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008312 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8313 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8314 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008315
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008316 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008317 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8318 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8319 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008320
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008321 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8322 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8323 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8324 documentation.
8325
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008326 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8327 declared inline.
8328
8329 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8330 The allowed scopes are:
8331 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8332 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8333 (request and response)
8334 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8335 processing
8336 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8337 processing.
8338 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8339 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8340
8341 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8342 followed by some converters.
8343
8344 Example:
8345
8346 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8347
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008348 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008349 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8350 # and reject everything else.
8351 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8352 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008353 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008354 tcp-request content reject
8355
8356 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008357 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8358 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8359 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008360 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008361
8362 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8363 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8364 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008365 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008366 tcp-request content reject
8367
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008368 Example:
8369 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8370 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008371 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008372
8373 Example:
8374 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8375 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008376 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008377
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008378 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8379 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8380
8381 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008382 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008383 # protecting all our sites
8384 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008385 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8386 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008387 ...
8388 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8389
8390 backend http_dynamic
8391 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008392 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008393 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008394 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8395 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8396 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008397 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008399 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008400
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008401 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008402
8403
8404tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8405 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008407 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008408 Arguments :
8409 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8410 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8411 as explained at the top of this document.
8412
8413 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8414 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8415 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8416 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8417 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8418
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008419 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8420 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8421 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8422 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8423
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008424 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8425 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008426 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008427 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008428 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8429 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8430 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8431 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008432
8433 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8434 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8435 it pass through unaffected.
8436
8437 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8438 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8439 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008440 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008441 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8442 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008443 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8444 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8445 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008446
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008447 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008448 "timeout client".
8449
8450
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008451tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8452 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8454 no | no | yes | yes
8455 Arguments :
8456 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008457 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008458
8459 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8460
8461 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8462 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8463 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008464 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8465 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008466
8467 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8468
8469 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8470 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8471 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8472 inserted.
8473
8474 Two types of actions are supported :
8475 - accept :
8476 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8477 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8478 the rules evaluation.
8479
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008480 - close :
8481 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8482 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8483 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8484 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8485 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8486 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008487 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008488 protocols.
8489
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008490 - reject :
8491 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8492 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008493 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008494
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008495 - lua <function>
8496 Executes Lua.
8497
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008498 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8499 Sets a variable.
8500
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008501 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8502 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8503 for changing the default action to a reject.
8504
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008505 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8506 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8507 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8508 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008509 period.
8510
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008511 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8512 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8513 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8514 documentation.
8515
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008516 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8517 declared inline.
8518
8519 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8520 The allowed scopes are:
8521 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8522 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8523 (request and response)
8524 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8525 processing
8526 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8527 processing.
8528 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8529 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8530
8531 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8532 followed by some converters.
8533
8534 Example:
8535
8536 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8537
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008538 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8539
8540 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8541
8542
8543tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8544 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8546 no | no | yes | yes
8547 Arguments :
8548 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8549 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8550 as explained at the top of this document.
8551
8552 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8553
8554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008555timeout check <timeout>
8556 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8557 established.
8558
8559 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8560 yes | no | yes | yes
8561 Arguments:
8562 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8563 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8564 as explained at the top of this document.
8565
8566 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8567 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8568 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8569 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008570 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8571 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8572 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008573
8574 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8575 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8576
8577 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8578 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008579 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008580
8581 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8582 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8583 forget about it.
8584
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008585 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8586 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008587
8588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008589timeout client <timeout>
8590timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8591 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8593 yes | yes | yes | no
8594 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008595 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008596 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8597 as explained at the top of this document.
8598
8599 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8600 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8601 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8602 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8603 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8604 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8605 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8606 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008607 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008608 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008609 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8610 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008611 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8612 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008613
8614 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8615 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8616 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8617 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8618 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8619 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8620
8621 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8622 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8623 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8624
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008625 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008626
8627
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008628timeout client-fin <timeout>
8629 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8631 yes | yes | yes | no
8632 Arguments :
8633 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8634 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8635 as explained at the top of this document.
8636
8637 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8638 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8639 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8640 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8641 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8642 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8643 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8644 down in one direction.
8645
8646 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8647 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8648 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8649
8650 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8651
8652
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008653timeout connect <timeout>
8654timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8655 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8657 yes | no | yes | yes
8658 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008659 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008660 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8661 as explained at the top of this document.
8662
8663 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008664 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008665 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008666 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008667 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8668 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008669
8670 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8671 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8672 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8673 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8674 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8675 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8676
8677 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8678 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8679 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8680
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008681 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8682 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008683
8684
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008685timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8686 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8688 yes | yes | yes | yes
8689 Arguments :
8690 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8691 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8692 as explained at the top of this document.
8693
8694 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8695 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8696 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8697 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8698 once the request has started to present itself.
8699
8700 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8701 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8702 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8703 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8704 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8705
8706 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8707 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8708 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8709 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8710
8711 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8712 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8713 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8714 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8715 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008716 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008717
8718 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8719 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8720 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8721 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8722
8723 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8724
8725
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008726timeout http-request <timeout>
8727 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008729 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008730 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008731 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8733 as explained at the top of this document.
8734
8735 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8736 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8737 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8738 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8739 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8740 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8741 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008742 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8743 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8744 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8745 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8746 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008747 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8748 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008749
8750 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8751 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008752 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8753 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008754
8755 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8756 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8757 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8758 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8759 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8760
8761 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008762 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8763 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8764 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008765
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008766 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8767 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008768
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008769
8770timeout queue <timeout>
8771 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8773 yes | no | yes | yes
8774 Arguments :
8775 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8776 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8777 as explained at the top of this document.
8778
8779 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8780 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8781 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8782 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8783 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8784
8785 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8786 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8787 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8788 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8789
8790 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8791
8792
8793timeout server <timeout>
8794timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8795 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8797 yes | no | yes | yes
8798 Arguments :
8799 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8800 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8801 as explained at the top of this document.
8802
8803 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8804 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8805 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8806 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8807 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8808 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8809 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8810
8811 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8812 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8813 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8814 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8815 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008816 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008817 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008818 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8819 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8820 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8821 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008822
8823 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8824 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8825 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8826 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8827 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8828 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8829
8830 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8831 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8832 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8833
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008834 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008835
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008836
8837timeout server-fin <timeout>
8838 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8840 yes | no | yes | yes
8841 Arguments :
8842 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8843 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8844 as explained at the top of this document.
8845
8846 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8847 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8848 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8849 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8850 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8851 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8852 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8853 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8854 situations, it should not be needed.
8855
8856 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8857 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8858 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8859
8860 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8861
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008862
8863timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008864 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8866 yes | yes | yes | yes
8867 Arguments :
8868 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8869 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8870 as explained at the top of this document.
8871
8872 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8873 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8874 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8875
8876 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8877 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8878 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8879 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008880 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008881
8882 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8883
8884
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008885timeout tunnel <timeout>
8886 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8888 yes | no | yes | yes
8889 Arguments :
8890 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8891 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8892 as explained at the top of this document.
8893
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008894 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008895 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8896 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8897 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8898 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8899 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8900 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8901 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8902 specified.
8903
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008904 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8905 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8906 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8907 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8908 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8909 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8910 state.
8911
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008912 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8913 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8914 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8915 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8916 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8917
8918 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8919 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8920 forget about it.
8921
8922 Example :
8923 defaults http
8924 option http-server-close
8925 timeout connect 5s
8926 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008927 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008928 timeout server 30s
8929 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8930
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008931 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008932
8933
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008934transparent (deprecated)
8935 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008937 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008938 Arguments : none
8939
8940 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8941 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8942 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8943 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8944 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8945 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8946 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8947 appropriate server.
8948
8949 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8950
8951 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8952 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8953
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008954 See also: "option transparent"
8955
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008956unique-id-format <string>
8957 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8959 yes | yes | yes | no
8960 Arguments :
8961 <string> is a log-format string.
8962
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008963 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8964 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8965 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8966 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008967
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008968 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8969 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8970 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8971 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8972 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8973 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8974 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8975 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008976
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008977 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8978 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008979
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008980 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008981
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008982 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008983
8984 will generate:
8985
8986 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8987
8988 See also: "unique-id-header"
8989
8990unique-id-header <name>
8991 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8993 yes | yes | yes | no
8994 Arguments :
8995 <name> is the name of the header.
8996
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008997 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8998 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008999
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009000 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009001
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009002 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009003 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9004
9005 will generate:
9006
9007 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9008
9009 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009010
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009011use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009012 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9014 no | yes | yes | no
9015 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009016 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9017 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009018
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009019 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9020 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009021
9022 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9023 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9024 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009025 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9026 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9027 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9028 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009029
9030 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9031 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9032 assign the backend.
9033
9034 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9035 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9036 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9037 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9038 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9039 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9040
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009041 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009042 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009043 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9044 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9045 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9046
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009047 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9048 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9049 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9050 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9051 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9052 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9053 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9054 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9055 cannot be forced from the request.
9056
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009057 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009058 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9059 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9060
9061 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9062 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009063
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009064
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009065use-server <server> if <condition>
9066use-server <server> unless <condition>
9067 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9069 no | no | yes | yes
9070 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009071 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009072
9073 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9074
9075 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9076 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9077 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9078
9079 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9080 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9081 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9082 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9083 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9084 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9085 matches will assign the server.
9086
9087 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9088 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9089 with the next rules until one matches.
9090
9091 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9092 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9093 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9094 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9095
9096 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9097 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9098 stripped.
9099
9100 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9101 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9102 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9103 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9104
9105 Example :
9106 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9107 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9108 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9109 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9110 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9111 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9112 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9113 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9114 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9115
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009116 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009117
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009118
91195. Bind and Server options
9120--------------------------
9121
9122The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9123depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9124settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9125written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9126described in this section.
9127
9128
91295.1. Bind options
9130-----------------
9131
9132The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9133as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9134no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9135parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9136while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9137provided immediately after the setting name.
9138
9139The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9140
9141accept-proxy
9142 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009143 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9144 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009145 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9146 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9147 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9148 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9149 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9150 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9151 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009152 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9153 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009154
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009155alpn <protocols>
9156 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9157 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9158 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9159 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9160 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9161 initial NPN extension.
9162
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009163backlog <backlog>
9164 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9165 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9166
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009167ecdhe <named curve>
9168 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009169 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9170 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009171
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009172ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9174 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9175 client's certificate.
9176
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009177ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9179 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9180 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9181 error is ignored.
9182
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009183ca-sign-file <cafile>
9184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9185 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9186 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9187 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9188 'generate-certificates' for details.
9189
9190ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9192 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9193 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9194 'generate-certificates' for details.
9195
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009196ciphers <ciphers>
9197 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9198 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009199 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009200 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9201 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9202
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009203crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9205 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9206 to verify client's certificate.
9207
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009208crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9210 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9211 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9212 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9213 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9214 file.
9215
9216 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9217 are loaded.
9218
9219 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009220 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009221 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9222 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9223 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9224 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9225 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9226 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9227 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009228
9229 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9230 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9231 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9232 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009233 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9234 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009235
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009236 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009237
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009238 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9239 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009240 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009241 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9242 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9243 clients).
9244
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009245 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9246 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9247 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9248 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9249 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9250 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9251 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9252 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9253 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9254 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9255 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9256 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9257 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9258
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009259 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9260 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9261 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9262 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9263 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9264
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009265crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9267 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009268 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009269 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009270
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009271crt-list <file>
9272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009273 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9274 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009275
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009276 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009277
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009278 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9279 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9280 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9281 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9282 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9283 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9284 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9285 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009286
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009287defer-accept
9288 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9289 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9290 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9291 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9292 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9293 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9294 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9295 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9296 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9297 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9298 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9299
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009300force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009301 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009302 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009303 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9304 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009305
9306force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009307 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009308 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9309 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009310
9311force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009312 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009313 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9314 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009315
9316force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009317 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009318 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9319 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009320
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009321generate-certificates
9322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9323 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9324 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9325 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9326 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9327 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9328 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9329 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9330 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9331 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9332 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9333
9334 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9335 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9336 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9337 certificate is used many times.
9338
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009339gid <gid>
9340 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9341 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9342 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9343 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9344 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9345
9346group <group>
9347 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9348 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9349 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9350 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9351 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9352
9353id <id>
9354 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9355 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9356 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9357 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9358
9359interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009360 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9361 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9362 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9363 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9364 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9365 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9366 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009367
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009368level <level>
9369 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9370 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9371 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9372 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9373 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9374 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9375 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9376 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9377 counters).
9378 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9379 all counters).
9380
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009381maxconn <maxconn>
9382 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9383 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9384 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9385 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9386 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9387 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9388 eat all memory.
9389
9390mode <mode>
9391 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9392 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9393 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9394 UNIX sockets.
9395
9396mss <maxseg>
9397 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9398 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9399 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9400 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9401 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9402 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9403 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9404 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9405 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9406 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9407 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9408
9409name <name>
9410 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9411 page.
9412
9413nice <nice>
9414 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9415 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9416 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9417 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9418 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9419 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9420 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9421 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9422 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9423 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9424 one for an RDP socket.
9425
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009426no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009427 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009428 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009429 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009430 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9431 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009432 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009433
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009434no-tls-tickets
9435 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9436 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9437 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009438 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9439 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009440
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009441no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009443 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009444 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009445 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9446 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9447 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009448
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009449no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009450 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009451 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009452 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009453 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9454 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9455 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009456
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009457no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009458 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009459 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009460 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009461 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9462 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9463 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009464
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009465npn <protocols>
9466 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9467 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9468 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9469 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009470 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9471 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009472
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009473process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9474 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9475 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9476 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9477 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9478 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9479 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9480 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009481 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9482 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9483 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9484 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9485 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9486 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9487 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009488
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009489ssl
9490 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009491 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009492 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9493 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9494 to deciphered contents.
9495
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009496strict-sni
9497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9498 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9499 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9500 See the "crt" option for more information.
9501
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009502tcp-ut <delay>
9503 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9504 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9505 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9506 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9507 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9508 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9509 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9510 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9511 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9512 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9513 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9514
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009515tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009516 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009517 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9518 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9519 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9520 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9521 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9522 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9523 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009524 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9525 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9526 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009527
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009528tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9529 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9530 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9531 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9532 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9533 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9534 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9535 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9536 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9537 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9538 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9539
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009540transparent
9541 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9542 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9543 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9544 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9545 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9546 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9547 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9548 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9549 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9550 so check for support with your vendor.
9551
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009552v4v6
9553 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9554 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9555 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9556 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009557 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009558
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009559v6only
9560 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9561 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9562 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009563 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9564 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009565
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009566uid <uid>
9567 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9568 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9569 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9570 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9571 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9572
9573user <user>
9574 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9575 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9576 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9577 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9578 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9579
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009580verify [none|optional|required]
9581 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9582 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9583 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9584 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9585 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009586 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9587 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9588 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9589 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009590
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020095915.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009592------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009594The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9595which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9596arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9597settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9598after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9599Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9600address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009602 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009603 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009605The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009606
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009607addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009608 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9609 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9610 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9611 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9612 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009614 Supported in default-server: No
9615
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009616agent-check
9617 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009618 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9619 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9620 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9621 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009622
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009623 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009624 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009625 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9626 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9627 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009628
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009629 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9630 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009631
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009632 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9633 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9634 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009635
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009636 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9637 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9638 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009639
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009640 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9641 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9642 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9643 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9644 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9645 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9646 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009647
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009648 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9649 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009650
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009651 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9652 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9653 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9654 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9655 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9656 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9657 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9658 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9659 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009660
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009661 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9662 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009663 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9664 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9665 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9666 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009667
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009668 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9669 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009670
9671 Supported in default-server: No
9672
9673agent-inter <delay>
9674 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9675 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9676
9677 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9678 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9679 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9680 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9681 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9682 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9683 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9684 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9685 of backends use the same servers.
9686
9687 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9688
9689 Supported in default-server: Yes
9690
9691agent-port <port>
9692 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9693
9694 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9695
9696 Supported in default-server: Yes
9697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009698backup
9699 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9700 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9701 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9702 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9703 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9704 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009706 Supported in default-server: No
9707
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009708ca-file <cafile>
9709 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9710 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9711 server's certificate.
9712
9713 Supported in default-server: No
9714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009715check
9716 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009717 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9718 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9719 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9720 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9721 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9722 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9723 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009724 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9725 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9726 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009728 Supported in default-server: No
9729
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009730check-send-proxy
9731 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9732 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9733 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9734 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9735 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9736 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9737 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9738
9739 Supported in default-server: No
9740
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009741check-ssl
9742 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9743 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9744 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9745 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009746 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009747 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9748 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9749 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9750 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9751
9752 Supported in default-server: No
9753
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009754ciphers <ciphers>
9755 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009756 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009757 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9758 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9759 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9760 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9761 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9762 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9763
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009764 Supported in default-server: No
9765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009766cookie <value>
9767 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9768 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9769 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9770 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9771 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9772 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9773 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009775 Supported in default-server: No
9776
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009777crl-file <crlfile>
9778 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9779 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9780 to verify server's certificate.
9781
9782 Supported in default-server: No
9783
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009784crt <cert>
9785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9786 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9787 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9788 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9789 certificate request.
9790
9791 Supported in default-server: No
9792
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009793disabled
9794 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9795 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9796 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9797 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9798 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9799
9800 Supported in default-server: No
9801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009802error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009803 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9804 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9805 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009807 Supported in default-server: Yes
9808
9809 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009810
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009811fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009812 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9813 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9814 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009816 Supported in default-server: Yes
9817
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009818force-sslv3
9819 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9820 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009821 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9822 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009823
9824 Supported in default-server: No
9825
9826force-tlsv10
9827 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009828 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9829 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009830
9831 Supported in default-server: No
9832
9833force-tlsv11
9834 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009835 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9836 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009837
9838 Supported in default-server: No
9839
9840force-tlsv12
9841 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009842 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9843 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009844
9845 Supported in default-server: No
9846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009847id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009848 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9849 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9850 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009852 Supported in default-server: No
9853
9854inter <delay>
9855fastinter <delay>
9856downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009857 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9858 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9859 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9860 between checks depending on the server state :
9861
9862 Server state | Interval used
9863 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9864 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9865 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9866 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9867 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9868 or yet unchecked. |
9869 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9870 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9871 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009873 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9874 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9875 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9876 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009877 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9878 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9879 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9880 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9881 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009883 Supported in default-server: Yes
9884
9885maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009886 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9887 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9888 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9889 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9890 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9891 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9892 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9893 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009895 Supported in default-server: Yes
9896
9897maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009898 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9899 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9900 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9901 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9902 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9903 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9904 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009906 Supported in default-server: Yes
9907
9908minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009909 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9910 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9911 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9912 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9913 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9914 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009915 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009916 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009918 Supported in default-server: Yes
9919
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009920no-ssl-reuse
9921 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9922 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9923 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9924 and for paranoid users.
9925
9926 Supported in default-server: No
9927
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009928no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009929 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9930 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009931 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009932
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009933 Supported in default-server: No
9934
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009935no-tls-tickets
9936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9937 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9938 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009939 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9940 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009941
9942 Supported in default-server: No
9943
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009944no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009945 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009946 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9947 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009948 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9949 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9950 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009951
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009952 Supported in default-server: No
9953
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009954no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009955 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009956 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9957 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009958 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9959 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9960 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009961
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009962 Supported in default-server: No
9963
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009964no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009965 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009966 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9967 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009968 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9969 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9970 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009971
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009972 Supported in default-server: No
9973
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009974non-stick
9975 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9976 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9977 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9978
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009979 Supported in default-server: No
9980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009981observe <mode>
9982 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9983 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9984 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9985 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9986 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9987 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009988 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009990 Supported in default-server: No
9991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009992 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009994on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009995 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9996 Currently, four modes are available:
9997 - fastinter: force fastinter
9998 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9999 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10000 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10001 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10002
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010003 Supported in default-server: Yes
10004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010005 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10006
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010007on-marked-down <action>
10008 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10009 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010010 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10011 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10012 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10013 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10014 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10015 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10016 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10017 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010018
10019 Actions are disabled by default
10020
10021 Supported in default-server: Yes
10022
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010023on-marked-up <action>
10024 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10025 Currently one action is available:
10026 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10027 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10028 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10029 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10030 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10031 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10032 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10033 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10034
10035 Actions are disabled by default
10036
10037 Supported in default-server: Yes
10038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010039port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010040 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10041 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10042 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10043 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10044 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10045 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010047 Supported in default-server: Yes
10048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010049redir <prefix>
10050 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10051 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10052 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10053 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10054 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10055 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10056 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10057 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010058 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010059 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10060 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10061 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10062 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10063 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10064
10065 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010067 Supported in default-server: No
10068
10069rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010070 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10071 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10072 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010074 Supported in default-server: Yes
10075
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010076resolve-prefer <family>
10077 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10078 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10079 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10080 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10081
10082 Default value: ipv4
10083
10084 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10085
10086resolvers <id>
10087 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10088 hostname.
10089
10090 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns
10091
10092 See also chapter 5.3
10093
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010094send-proxy
10095 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10096 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10097 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10098 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10099 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10100 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10101 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10102 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10103 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010104 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10105 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10106 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10107 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10108 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010109
10110 Supported in default-server: No
10111
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010112send-proxy-v2
10113 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10114 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10115 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10116 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10117 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10118 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10119 option of the "bind" keyword.
10120
10121 Supported in default-server: No
10122
10123send-proxy-v2-ssl
10124 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10125 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10126 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10127 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10128 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10129 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10130 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10131 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10132
10133 Supported in default-server: No
10134
10135send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10136 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10137 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10138 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10139 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10140 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10141 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10142 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10143 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10144 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10145
10146 Supported in default-server: No
10147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010148slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010149 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10150 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10151 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10152 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10153 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10154 parameters :
10155
10156 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10157 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10158
10159 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10160 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10161 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10162 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10163
10164 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10165 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10166 seen as failed.
10167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010168 Supported in default-server: Yes
10169
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010170source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010171source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010172source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010173 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10174 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10175 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10176 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10177
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010178 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10179 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10180 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10181 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10182 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10183 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10184 server.
10185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010186 Supported in default-server: No
10187
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010188ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010189 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10190 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10191 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10192 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10193 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10194 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010195 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010196
10197 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010199track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010200 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10201 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10202 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10203 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010204 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010206 Supported in default-server: No
10207
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010208verify [none|required]
10209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010210 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10211 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10212 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10213 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010214 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10215 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10216 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010217
10218 Supported in default-server: No
10219
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010220verifyhost <hostname>
10221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10222 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10223 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10224 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10225 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10226 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10227
10228 Supported in default-server: No
10229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010230weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010231 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10232 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10233 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010234 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10235 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10236 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10237 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10238 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10239 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010241 Supported in default-server: Yes
10242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010243
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200102445.3 Server IP address resolution using DNS
10245------------------------------------------
10246
10247HAProxy allows using a host name to be resolved to find out what is the server
10248IP address. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10249configuration, at startup.
10250This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10251can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10252workload.
10253This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10254resolution at run time.
10255Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10256carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10257
10258
102595.3.1 Global overview
10260---------------------
10261
10262As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10263different steps of the process life:
10264
10265 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10266 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10267 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10268
10269 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10270 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10271 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10272
10273A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10274 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10275 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10276 resolution to know this new IP.
10277
10278A few things important to notice:
10279 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10280 first valid response.
10281
10282 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10283 servers return an error.
10284
10285
102865.3.2 The resolvers section
10287---------------------------
10288
10289This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10290HAProxy.
10291There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10292many name servers.
10293
10294resolvers <resolvers id>
10295 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10296
10297A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10298
10299nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10300 DNS server description:
10301 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10302 <ip> : IP address of the server
10303 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10304
10305hold <status> <period>
10306 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10307 on last resolution <status>
10308 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10309 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10310 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10311 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10312
10313 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10314
10315 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10316 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10317 the healch check.
10318
10319resolve_retries <nb>
10320 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10321 giving up.
10322 Default value: 3
10323
10324timeout <event> <time>
10325 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10326 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10327 events available are:
10328 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10329 been received.
10330 Default value: 1s
10331 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10332 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10333
10334Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10335
10336 resolvers mydns
10337 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10338 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10339 resolve_retries 3
10340 timeout retry 1s
10341 hold valid 10s
10342
10343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103446. HTTP header manipulation
10345---------------------------
10346
10347In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10348response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10349request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10350which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010351against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010352
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010353If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10354to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10355but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10356HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10357stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10358because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10359a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10360still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010362This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10363in section 4.2 :
10364
10365 - reqadd <string>
10366 - reqallow <search>
10367 - reqiallow <search>
10368 - reqdel <search>
10369 - reqidel <search>
10370 - reqdeny <search>
10371 - reqideny <search>
10372 - reqpass <search>
10373 - reqipass <search>
10374 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10375 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10376 - reqtarpit <search>
10377 - reqitarpit <search>
10378 - rspadd <string>
10379 - rspdel <search>
10380 - rspidel <search>
10381 - rspdeny <search>
10382 - rspideny <search>
10383 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10384 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10385
10386With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10387is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10388parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10389prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10390Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10391
10392 \t for a tab
10393 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10394 \n for a new line (LF)
10395 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10396 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10397 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10398 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10399 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10400
10401The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10402portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10403above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10404regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
104059 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10406is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10407
10408The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10409after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10410
10411Notes related to these keywords :
10412---------------------------------
10413 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10414 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10415 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10416
10417 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10418 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10419 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10420
10421 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10422 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10423 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10424 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10425 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10426
10427 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10428 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10429 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10430 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10431 useless headers before adding new ones.
10432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010433 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010434 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10435
10436 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10437 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10438 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10439
10440 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10441 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010442 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010443
10444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200104457. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10446----------------------------------
10447
10448Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10449client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10450The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10451these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10452but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10453data called patterns.
10454
10455
104567.1. ACL basics
10457---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010458
10459The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10460content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10461from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10462simple :
10463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010464 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010465 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010466 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10467 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010469The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10470adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010471
10472In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010474 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010475
10476This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10477Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10478and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010479an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10480conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10481as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10482are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010483
10484ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10485'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10486which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10487
10488There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10489performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010491The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10492specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10493this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010494methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10495ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010496
10497Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10498 - boolean
10499 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10500 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10501 - string
10502 - data block
10503
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010504Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10505converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10506would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10507The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10508which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10509
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010510Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10511keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10512fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10513which are summarized in the table below :
10514
10515 +---------------------+-----------------+
10516 | Sample or converter | Default |
10517 | output type | matching method |
10518 +---------------------+-----------------+
10519 | boolean | bool |
10520 +---------------------+-----------------+
10521 | integer | int |
10522 +---------------------+-----------------+
10523 | ip | ip |
10524 +---------------------+-----------------+
10525 | string | str |
10526 +---------------------+-----------------+
10527 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10528 +---------------------+-----------------+
10529
10530Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10531matching method, see below.
10532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010533The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10534 - boolean
10535 - integer or integer range
10536 - IP address / network
10537 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10538 - regular expression
10539 - hex block
10540
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010541The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10542
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010543 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10544 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010545 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010546 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010547 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010548 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010549 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010551The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10552read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10553if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10554lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10555will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10556beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10557a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10558lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10559exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10560
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010561The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10562parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10563ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10564a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10565check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10566
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010567The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10568socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10569file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10572loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10573
10574 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10575
10576In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10577the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10578case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10579as well.
10580
10581The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10582sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10583do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10584methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10585is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10586obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10587followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10588default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10589that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10590string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10591
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010592The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10593By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10594string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10595resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10596server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10597waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10598flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10599function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010601There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10602sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10603be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010604
10605 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10606 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010607 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10608 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10609 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10610 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010611
10612 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10613 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010614 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010615
10616 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010617 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010618
10619 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010620 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010621
10622 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10623 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10624
10625 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10626 binary or string samples.
10627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10629 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010631 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10632 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10633 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010635 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10636 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010638 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10639 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010641 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10642 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010644 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10645 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010646 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010648 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10649 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10650 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010651
10652For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10653request, it is possible to do :
10654
10655 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10656
10657In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10658buffer, one would use the following acl :
10659
10660 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10661
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010662On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10663possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10664
10665 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010667All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10668criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10669method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10670to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10671criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10672the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010674If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010675the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10676For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010678 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10679 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10680 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10681 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010682
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010683
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010684The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10685types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10686combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10687brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10688default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010690 +-------------------------------------------------+
10691 | Input sample type |
10692 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010693 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010694 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10695 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10696 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010697 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010698 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010699 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010700 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010701 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010702 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010703 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010704 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010705 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010706 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010707 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010708 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010709 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010710 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010711 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010712 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010713 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010714 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010715 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010716 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010717 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010718 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10719 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10720 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010721
10722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107237.1.1. Matching booleans
10724------------------------
10725
10726In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10727Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10728When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10729that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10730
10731Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10732return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10733"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10734
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107367.1.2. Matching integers
10737------------------------
10738
10739Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10740enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10741to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10742
10743Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10744matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10745lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010746
10747For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10748unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10749representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10750
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010751As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10752two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10753instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10754ranges and operators.
10755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010756For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010757operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10758Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10759of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010761Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010762
10763 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10764 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10765 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10766 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10767 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010769For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010770
10771 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10772
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010773This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10774
10775 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10776
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200107787.1.3. Matching strings
10779-----------------------
10780
10781String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10782different forms :
10783
10784 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10785 patterns ;
10786
10787 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10788 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10789
10790 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10791 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10792
10793 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10794 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10795
10796 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10797 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10798 matches.
10799
10800 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10801 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10802 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010803
10804String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10805exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10806characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10807string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10808to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010809before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010810
10811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108127.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10813---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010814
10815Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10816they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10817possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10818passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10819the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010820the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10821match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010822
10823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108247.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10825-------------------------------------
10826
10827It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10828not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10829a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10830to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10831digits may be used upper or lower case.
10832
10833Example :
10834 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10835 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10836
10837
108387.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10839---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010840
10841IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10842netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10843within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010844host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010845difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10846at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10847does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10848parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010849
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010850IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10851Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10852trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10853IPv6 patterns.
10854
10855HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10856following situations :
10857 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10858 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10859 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10860 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10861 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10862 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10863 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10864 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10865 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10866 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010868
108697.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10870----------------------------------
10871
10872Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10873combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10874
10875 - AND (implicit)
10876 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10877 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010879A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010881 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010883Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10884indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010886For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10887"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10888requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10889is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10890
10891 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10892 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10893 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10894 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10895
10896To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10897and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10898
10899 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10900 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10901 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10902 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10903
10904 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10905 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10906 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10907 use_backend www if host_www
10908
10909It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10910expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10911be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10912the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10913
10914 The following rule :
10915
10916 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10917 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10918
10919 Can also be written that way :
10920
10921 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10922
10923It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10924to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10925simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10926sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10927good use is the following :
10928
10929 With named ACLs :
10930
10931 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10932 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10933 monitor fail if site_dead
10934
10935 With anonymous ACLs :
10936
10937 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10938
10939See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10940
10941
109427.3. Fetching samples
10943---------------------
10944
10945Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10946against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10947sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10948ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10949of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10950available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10951
10952This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10953Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10954compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10955deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10956
10957The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10958matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10959method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10960indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10961
10962As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10963when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10964mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10965the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10966ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10967
10968Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10969multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10970when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10971incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10972are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10973is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10974all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10975
10976Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10977 - name
10978 - name(arg1)
10979 - name(arg1,arg2)
10980
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010981
109827.3.1. Converters
10983-----------------
10984
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010985Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10986of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10987is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10988was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10989has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10990unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10991
10992These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10993sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10994the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10995support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010996
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010997A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10998support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10999supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11000(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11001bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011003The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011004
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011005add(<value>)
11006 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
11007 result as an unsigned integer.
11008
11009and(<value>)
11010 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
11011 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11012
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011013base64
11014 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11015 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11016 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11017
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011018bool
11019 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
11020 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11021 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11022 presence of a flag).
11023
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011024bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11025 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11026 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11027 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11028
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011029cpl
11030 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
11031 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11032
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011033crc32([<avalanche>])
11034 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11035 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11036 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11037 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11038 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11039 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11040 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11041 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11042 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11043 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11044 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11045
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011046da-csv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
11047 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11048 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11049 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11050 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
11051 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
11052 configuration language.
11053
11054 Example:
11055 frontend www
11056 bind *:8881
11057 default_backend servers
11058 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
11059
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011060debug
11061 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11062 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11063 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11064
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011065div(<value>)
11066 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
11067 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
11068 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
11069
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011070djb2([<avalanche>])
11071 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11072 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11073 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11074 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11075 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11076 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11077 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011078 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11079 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011080
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011081even
11082 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
11083 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11084
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011085field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11086 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11087 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11088 list of chars.
11089
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011090hex
11091 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11092 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11093 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11094 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011095
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011096http_date([<offset>])
11097 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11098 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11099 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11100 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11101 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11102 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011103
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011104in_table(<table>)
11105 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11106 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11107 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11108 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11109 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11110
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011111ipmask(<mask>)
11112 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11113 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11114 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11115 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11116
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011117json([<input-code>])
11118 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11119 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11120 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11121 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11122 of errors:
11123 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11124 bytes, ...)
11125 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11126 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11127
11128 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11129 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11130 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11131 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11132 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11133 are :
11134 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11135 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11136 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11137 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11138 error ;
11139 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11140 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11141
11142 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11143 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11144
11145 Example:
11146 capture request header user-agent len 150
11147 capture request header Host len 15
11148 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11149
11150 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11151 GET / HTTP/1.0
11152 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11153
11154 Output log:
11155 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11156
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011157language(<value>[,<default>])
11158 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11159 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11160 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11161 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11162 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11163 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11164 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11165 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11166 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11167 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11168 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11169 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011170
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011171 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011172
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011173 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11174 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011175
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011176 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11177 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11178 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11179 use_backend spanish if es
11180 use_backend french if fr
11181 use_backend english if en
11182 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011183
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011184lower
11185 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11186 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11187 type. The result is of type string.
11188
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011189ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11190 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11191 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11192 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11193 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11194 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11195 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11196
11197 Example :
11198
11199 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11200 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11201 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11202
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011203map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11204map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11205map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11206 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11207 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11208 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11209 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11210 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11211 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11212 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11213 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011214
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011215 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11216 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11217 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011218
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011219 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11220 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011221
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011222 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11223 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11224 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11225 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011226 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11227 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011228 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11229 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11230 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11231 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11232 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11233 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11234 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11235 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11236 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11237 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11238 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11239 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11240 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11241 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011242
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011243 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11244 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11245 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11246 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11247 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011248
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011249 Example :
11250
11251 # this is a comment and is ignored
11252 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11253 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11254 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11255 | | | `---------- value
11256 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11257 | `---------------------------- key
11258 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11259
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011260mod(<value>)
11261 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
11262 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
11263
11264mul(<value>)
11265 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
11266 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
11267 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
11268
11269neg
11270 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
11271 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
11272 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
11273 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11274
11275not
11276 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
11277 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11278 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11279 absence of a flag).
11280
11281odd
11282 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
11283 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11284
11285or(<value>)
11286 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
11287 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11288
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011289regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011290 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11291 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11292 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11293 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11294 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11295 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11296 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11297 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11298 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11299 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11300 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11301 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11302 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11303
11304 Example :
11305
11306 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11307 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11308 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11309 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11310
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011311capture-req(<id>)
11312 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11313 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11314
11315 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11316 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11317 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11318
11319capture-res(<id>)
11320 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11321 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11322
11323 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11324 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11325 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11326
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011327sdbm([<avalanche>])
11328 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11329 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11330 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11331 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11332 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11333 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11334 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011335 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11336 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011337
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011338set-var(<var name>)
11339 Sets a variable with the input content and return the content on the output as
11340 is. The variable keep the value and the associated input type. The name of the
11341 variable starts by an indication about it scope. The scope allowed are:
11342 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11343 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11344 response),
11345 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11346 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11347 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11348 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11349
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011350sub(<value>)
11351 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
11352 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
11353 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
11354
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011355table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11356 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11357 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11358 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11359 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11360 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11361 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11362
11363
11364table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11365 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11366 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11367 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11368 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11369 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11370 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11371
11372table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11373 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11374 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11375 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11376 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11377 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11378
11379table_conn_cur(<table>)
11380 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11381 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11382 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11383 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11384 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11385
11386table_conn_rate(<table>)
11387 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11388 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11389 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11390 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11391 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11392
11393table_gpc0(<table>)
11394 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11395 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11396 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11397 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11398 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11399
11400table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11401 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11402 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11403 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11404 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11405 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11406 sample fetch keyword.
11407
11408table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11409 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11410 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11411 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11412 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11413 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11414
11415table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11416 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11417 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11418 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11419 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11420 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11421 keyword.
11422
11423table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11424 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11425 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11426 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11427 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11428 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11429
11430table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11431 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11432 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11433 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11434 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11435 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11436 keyword.
11437
11438table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11439 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11440 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11441 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11442 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11443 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11444 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11445 keyword.
11446
11447table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11448 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11449 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11450 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11451 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11452 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11453 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11454 keyword.
11455
11456table_server_id(<table>)
11457 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11458 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11459 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11460 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11461 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11462 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11463
11464table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11465 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11466 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11467 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11468 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11469 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11470 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11471 keyword.
11472
11473table_sess_rate(<table>)
11474 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11475 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11476 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11477 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11478 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11479 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11480 keyword.
11481
11482table_trackers(<table>)
11483 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11484 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11485 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11486 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11487 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11488 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11489 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11490 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11491 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11492 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11493
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011494upper
11495 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11496 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11497 type. The result is of type string.
11498
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011499url_dec
11500 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11501 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11502
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011503utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11504 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11505 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11506 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11507 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11508 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11509 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11510
11511 Example :
11512
11513 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11514 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11515 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11516
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011517word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11518 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11519 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11520
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011521wt6([<avalanche>])
11522 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11523 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11524 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11525 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11526 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11527 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11528 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011529 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11530 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011531
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011532xor(<value>)
11533 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
11534 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
11535
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011536
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200115377.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011538--------------------------------------------
11539
11540A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11541not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11542"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11543The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11544
11545always_false : boolean
11546 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11547 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11548
11549always_true : boolean
11550 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11551 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11552
11553avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011554 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011555 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11556 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11557 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11558 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11559 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11560 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11561 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11562 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11563 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11564 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11565 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11566 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11567 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011569be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011570 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11571 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11572 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11573 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11574 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011576be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11577 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11578 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11579 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11580 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11581 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11582 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011583
11584 Example :
11585 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11586 backend dynamic
11587 mode http
11588 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11589 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011590
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011591bin(<hexa>) : bin
11592 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
11593 of the string.
11594
11595bool(<bool>) : bool
11596 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
11597 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
11598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011599connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11600 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011601 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011602 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11603 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011604
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011605 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011606 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011607 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11608
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011609 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11610 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011611
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011612 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011613 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011614 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011615 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11616 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011617 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011618 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011619
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011620 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11621 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011622 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011623 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011624
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011625date([<offset>]) : integer
11626 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11627 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11628 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11629 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011630 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11631
11632 Example :
11633
11634 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11635 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011636
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011637env(<name>) : string
11638 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11639 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11640 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11641 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11642 certain way.
11643
11644 Examples :
11645 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11646 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11647
11648 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11649 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011651fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11652 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011653 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11654 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011655 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11656 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11657 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11658 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11659 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011661fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11662 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11663 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11664 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11665 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11666 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11667 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11668 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11669 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011670
11671 Example :
11672 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11673 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11674 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11675 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11676 frontend mail
11677 bind :25
11678 mode tcp
11679 maxconn 100
11680 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11681 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11682 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11683 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011684
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011685ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
11686 Returns an ipv4.
11687
11688ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
11689 Returns an ipv6.
11690
11691meth(<method>) : method
11692 Returns a method.
11693
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011694nbproc : integer
11695 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11696 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11697 and debugging purposes.
11698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011699nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11700 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11701 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11702 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011703 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11704 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11705 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011706
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011707proc : integer
11708 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11709 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11710 debugging purposes.
11711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011712queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011713 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11714 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11715 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011716 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11717 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11718 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11719 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11720 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11721
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011722rand([<range>]) : integer
11723 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11724 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11725 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11726 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11727 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11728
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011729sint(<sint>) : signed integer
11730 Returns a signed integer.
11731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011732srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11733 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11734 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11735 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11736 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11737 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11738 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11739 methods.
11740
11741srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11742 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11743 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11744 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11745 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11746 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11747 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11748 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11749
11750srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11751 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11752 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011753 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011754 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11755 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11756 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11757 overloading servers).
11758
11759 Example :
11760 # Redirect to a separate back
11761 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11762 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11763 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11764
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011765stopping : boolean
11766 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11767 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11768 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11769
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011770str(<string>) : string
11771 Returns a string.
11772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011773table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11774 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11775 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11776
11777table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11778 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11779 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11780 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11781
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011782uint(<uint>) : unsigned integer
11783 Returns an unsigned integer.
11784
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011785var(<var-name>) : undefined
11786 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
11787 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11788 scope. The scope allowed are:
11789 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11790 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11791 response),
11792 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11793 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11794 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11795 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011797
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200117987.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011799----------------------------------
11800
11801The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11802closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11803methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11804sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11805TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011806the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11807counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11808"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011809argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11810the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11811this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011812
11813be_id : integer
11814 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11815 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11816
11817dst : ip
11818 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11819 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11820 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11821 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11822 RFC 4291.
11823
11824dst_conn : integer
11825 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11826 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11827 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11828 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11829 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11830 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11831 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11832 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011834dst_port : integer
11835 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11836 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11837 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11838 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11839 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11840 an HTTP header.
11841
11842fe_id : integer
11843 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11844 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11845 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11846
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011847sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011848sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11849sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11850sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011851 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11852 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11853 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11854
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011855sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011856sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11857sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11858sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011859 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11860 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11861 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11862
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011863sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011864sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11865sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11866sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011867 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11868 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011869 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11870 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11871 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011872
11873 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11874 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011875 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11876 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11877 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011878 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11879 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11880
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011881sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011882sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11883sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11884sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011885 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11886 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11887
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011888sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011889sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11890sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11891sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011892 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11893 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11894 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11895
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011896sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011897sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11898sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11899sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011900 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11901 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11902 See also src_conn_rate.
11903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011904sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011905sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11906sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11907sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011908 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011909 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011910
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011911sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011912sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11913sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11914sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011915 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11916 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11917 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011918 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11919 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11920 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011921
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011922sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011923sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11924sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11925sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011926 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11927 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11928 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011930sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011931sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11932sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11933sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011934 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11935 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11936 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11937 src_http_err_rate.
11938
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011939sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011940sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11941sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11942sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011943 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11944 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11945 src_http_req_cnt.
11946
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011947sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011948sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11949sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11950sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011951 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11952 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11953 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11954 src_http_req_rate.
11955
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011956sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011957sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11958sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11959sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011960 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011961 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11962 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11963 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11964 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011965
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011966 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11967 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011968 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11969
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011970sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011971sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11972sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11973sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011974 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11975 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11976 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011977
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011978sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011979sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11980sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11981sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011982 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11983 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11984 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011985
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011986sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011987sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11988sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11989sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011990 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11991 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11992 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11993 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011994 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011995 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11996
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011997sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011998sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11999sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12000sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012001 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12002 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12003 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12004 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12005 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012006 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012007
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012008sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012009sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12010sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12011sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012012 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12013 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12014 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12015
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012016sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012017sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12018sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12019sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012020 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12021 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012022 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012023 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12024 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012025 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12026 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12027 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012029so_id : integer
12030 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12031 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12032 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012034src : ip
12035 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12036 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12037 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12038 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12039 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12040 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12041 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012042
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012043 Example:
12044 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12045 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012047src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12048 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12049 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12050 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012051 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012053src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12054 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12055 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012056 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012057 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012059src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12060 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12061 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12062 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12063 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12064 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12065 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012066
12067 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12068 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12069 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12070 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012071 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012072 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12073 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012075src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012076 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012077 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012078 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012079 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012081src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012082 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012083 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12084 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012085 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012087src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12088 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12089 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12090 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012091 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012093src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012094 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012095 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012096 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012097 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012099src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012100 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012101 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012102 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12103 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012104 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12105 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12106 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012108src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12109 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12110 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012111 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012112 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012113 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012115src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12116 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12117 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12118 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12119 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012120 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012122src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12123 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12124 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12125 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012126 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012128src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12129 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12130 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12131 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012132 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012133 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012135src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12136 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12137 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12138 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012139 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012140 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12141 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012142
12143 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012144 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012145 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012147src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012148 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12149 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12150 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12151 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12152 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012154src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012155 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12156 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12157 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12158 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12159 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012161src_port : integer
12162 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12163 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12164 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12165 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012167src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12168 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012169 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12170 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12171 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012172 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012174src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12175 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12176 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12177 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12178 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012179 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012181src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12182 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12183 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12184 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12185 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12186 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12187 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12188 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12189 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012190
12191 Example :
12192 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12193 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12194 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12195 listen ssh
12196 bind :22
12197 mode tcp
12198 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012199 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012200 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012201 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012203srv_id : integer
12204 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12205 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12206 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012207
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012208
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200122097.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012210----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012212The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12213closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12214when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12215usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012216future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012217
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012218ssl_bc : boolean
12219 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12220 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12221 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12222
12223ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12224 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12225 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12226
12227ssl_bc_cipher : string
12228 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12229 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12230
12231ssl_bc_protocol : string
12232 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12233 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12234
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012235ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012236 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012237 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12238 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012239
12240ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12241 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12242 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12243 if session was reused or not.
12244
12245ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12246 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12247 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012249ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12250 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12251 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12252 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12253 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12254 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012256ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12257 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12258 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12259 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12260 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012261
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012262ssl_c_der : binary
12263 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12264 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12265 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012267ssl_c_err : integer
12268 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12269 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12270 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12271 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12272 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012274ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12275 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12276 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12277 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12278 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12279 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12280 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12281 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12282 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012284ssl_c_key_alg : string
12285 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12286 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12287 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012289ssl_c_notafter : string
12290 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12291 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12292 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012294ssl_c_notbefore : string
12295 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
12296 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12297 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012299ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12300 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12301 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12302 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12303 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12304 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12305 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12306 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12307 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012309ssl_c_serial : binary
12310 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12311 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12312 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012314ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12315 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12316 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12317 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012318 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12319 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12320
12321 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012323ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12324 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12325 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12326 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012328ssl_c_used : boolean
12329 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12330 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012332ssl_c_verify : integer
12333 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12334 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12335 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12336 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012338ssl_c_version : integer
12339 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12340 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012341
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012342ssl_f_der : binary
12343 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12344 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12345 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012347ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12348 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12349 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12350 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12351 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012352 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012353 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12354 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12355 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012357ssl_f_key_alg : string
12358 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12359 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12360 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012362ssl_f_notafter : string
12363 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12364 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12365 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012367ssl_f_notbefore : string
12368 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12369 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12370 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012372ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12373 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12374 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12375 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12376 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12377 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12378 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12379 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12380 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012382ssl_f_serial : binary
12383 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12384 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12385 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012386
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012387ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12388 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12389 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12390 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012392ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12393 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12394 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12395 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012397ssl_f_version : integer
12398 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12399 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12400
12401ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012402 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12403 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12404 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012406 Example :
12407 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12408 listen http-https
12409 bind :80
12410 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12411 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12412
12413ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12414 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12415 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12416
12417ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012418 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012419 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12420 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12421 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12422 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12423 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12424 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12425 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12426 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012428ssl_fc_cipher : string
12429 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12430 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012432ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012433 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12434 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012435 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12436 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12437 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12438 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012440ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12441 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012442 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12443 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12444 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12445 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012446
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012447ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12448 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12449 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012451ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012452 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012453 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12454 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12455 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12456 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12457 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12458 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12459 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012461ssl_fc_protocol : string
12462 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12463 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012464
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012465ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012466 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012467 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12468 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012470ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12471 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12472 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12473 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12474 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012476ssl_fc_sni : string
12477 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12478 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12479 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12480 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12481 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12482
12483 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12484 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12485 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012486 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12487 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012489 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012490 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12491 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012493ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12494 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12495 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012496
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012497
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124987.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012499------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012501Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12502sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12503only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12504For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12505be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12506can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12507sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12508for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12509content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012511payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12512 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12513 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12514 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012516payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12517 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12518 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12519 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012521req.len : integer
12522req_len : integer (deprecated)
12523 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12524 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12525 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12526 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12527 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12528 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12529 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12530 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012532req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12533 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012534 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12535 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12536 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12537 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012539 ACL alternatives :
12540 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012542req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12543 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12544 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12545 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12546 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548 ACL alternatives :
12549 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012551 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012553req.proto_http : boolean
12554req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12555 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12556 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12557 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12558 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12559 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12560 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12561 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012563 Example:
12564 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12565 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12566 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012567 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012569req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12570rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12571 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12572 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12573 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12574 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12575 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12576 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12577 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012579 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12580 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12581 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12582 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12583 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12584 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012586 ACL derivatives :
12587 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012589 Example :
12590 listen tse-farm
12591 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12592 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12593 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12594 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12595 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12596 persist rdp-cookie
12597 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12598 # This is only useful makes sense if
12599 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12600 stick-table type string size 204800
12601 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12602 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12603 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012605 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12606 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012608req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12609rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12610 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12611 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12612 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12613 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012615 ACL derivatives :
12616 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012618req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12619req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12620 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12621 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12622 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12623 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12624 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12625 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12626 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012628req.ssl_sni : string
12629req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12630 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12631 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12632 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12633 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12634 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12635 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12636 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12637 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12638 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12639 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12640 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12641 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012643 ACL derivatives :
12644 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012646 Examples :
12647 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12648 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12649 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12650 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12651 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012653res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12654rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12655 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12656 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12657 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12658 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12659 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12660 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12661 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012663req.ssl_ver : integer
12664req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12665 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12666 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12667 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12668 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12669 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12670 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12671 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12672 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12673 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012675 ACL derivatives :
12676 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012677
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012678res.len : integer
12679 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12680 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12681 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12682 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12683 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12684 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12685 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12686 content inspection.
12687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012688res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12689 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012690 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12691 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12692 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12693 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012695res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12696 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12697 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12698 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12699 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012703wait_end : boolean
12704 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12705 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12706 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12707 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12708 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12709 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12710 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12711 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012713 Examples :
12714 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12715 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12716 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012718 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12719 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12720 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12721 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12722 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12723 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12724 tcp-request content reject
12725
12726
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200127277.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012728--------------------------------------
12729
12730It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12731This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12732data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12733its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12734HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12735content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12736to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12737more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12738response are indexed.
12739
12740base : string
12741 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12742 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12743 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12744 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12745 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12746 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12747 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12748 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12749
12750 ACL derivatives :
12751 base : exact string match
12752 base_beg : prefix match
12753 base_dir : subdir match
12754 base_dom : domain match
12755 base_end : suffix match
12756 base_len : length match
12757 base_reg : regex match
12758 base_sub : substring match
12759
12760base32 : integer
12761 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12762 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12763 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012764 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12765 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12766 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767
12768base32+src : binary
12769 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12770 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12771 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12772 per-URL counters.
12773
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012774capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12775 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12776 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12777 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12778
12779capture.req.method : string
12780 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12781 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12782 because it's allocated.
12783
12784capture.req.uri : string
12785 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12786 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12787 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12788 allocated.
12789
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012790capture.req.ver : string
12791 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12792 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12793 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12794
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012795capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12796 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12797 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12798 The first entry is an index of 0.
12799 See also: "capture response header"
12800
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012801capture.res.ver : string
12802 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12803 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12804 persistent flag.
12805
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012806req.body : binary
12807 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
12808 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12809 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
12810 the first chunk is analyzed.
12811
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020012812req.body_param([<name>) : string
12813 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
12814 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
12815 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
12816 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
12817 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
12818 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
12819 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
12820 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
12821 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
12822 given.
12823
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020012824req.body_len : integer
12825 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
12826 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
12827 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
12828 "option http-buffer-request".
12829
12830req.body_size : integer
12831 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
12832 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
12833 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
12834 that the request body has been buffered made available using
12835 "option http-buffer-request".
12836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837req.cook([<name>]) : string
12838cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12839 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12840 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12841 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12842 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12843 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12844 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12845 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12846 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12847
12848 ACL derivatives :
12849 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12850 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12851 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12852 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12853 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12854 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12855 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12856 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012858req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12859cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12860 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12861 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012863req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12864cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12865 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12866 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12867 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12868 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012870cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12871 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12872 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12873 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12874 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12875 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12876 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12877 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12878 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12879 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12880 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012882hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12883 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12884 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12885 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12886 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012887 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012889req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12890 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12891 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12892 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12893 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12894 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12895 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12896 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12897 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012899req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12900 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12901 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12902 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12903 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012905req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12906 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12907 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12908 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12909 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12910 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12911 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12912 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12913 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12914 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12915 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12916 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918 ACL derivatives :
12919 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12920 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12921 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12922 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12923 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12924 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12925 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12926 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12927
12928req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12929hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12930 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12931 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12932 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12933 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12934 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12935 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12936 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12937 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12938 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12939
12940req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12941hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12942 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12943 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12944 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12945 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12946 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12947 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12948 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12949 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12950
12951req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12952hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12953 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12954 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12955 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12956 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12957 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12958 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12959 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12960
12961http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12962 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12963 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12964 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12965 basic auth is supported.
12966
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012967http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12968 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12969 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12970 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12971 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12973 basic auth is supported.
12974
12975 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012976 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12977 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12978 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12979 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012980
12981http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012982 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12983 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012984 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12985 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012987method : integer + string
12988 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12989 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12990 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12991 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12992 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12993 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12994 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012996 ACL derivatives :
12997 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012999 Example :
13000 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13001 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13002 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004path : string
13005 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13006 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13007 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13008 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13009 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13010 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13011 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013013 ACL derivatives :
13014 path : exact string match
13015 path_beg : prefix match
13016 path_dir : subdir match
13017 path_dom : domain match
13018 path_end : suffix match
13019 path_len : length match
13020 path_reg : regex match
13021 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013022
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013023query : string
13024 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13025 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13026 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13027 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13028 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13029 which stops before the question mark.
13030
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013031req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13032 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13033 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13034 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13035 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013037req.ver : string
13038req_ver : string (deprecated)
13039 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13040 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13041 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013043 ACL derivatives :
13044 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013046res.comp : boolean
13047 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13048 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13049 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013051res.comp_algo : string
13052 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13053 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13054 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056res.cook([<name>]) : string
13057scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13058 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13059 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13060 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062 ACL derivatives :
13063 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013065res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13066scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13067 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13068 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13069 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013071res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13072scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13073 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13074 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13075 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13078 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13079 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13080 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13081 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13082 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13083 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13084 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13085 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13086 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013088res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13089 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13090 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13091 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13092 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13093 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13096shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13097 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13098 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13099 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13100 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13101 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13102 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13103 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13104 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013106 ACL derivatives :
13107 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13108 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13109 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13110 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13111 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13112 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13113 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13114 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13115
13116res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13117shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13118 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13119 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13120 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13121 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13122 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13125shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13126 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13127 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13128 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13129 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13130 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13131 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013132
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013133res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13134 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13135 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13136 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13137 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013139res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13140shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13141 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13142 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13143 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13144 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13145 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13146 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013148res.ver : string
13149resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13150 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13151 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013153 ACL derivatives :
13154 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13157 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13158 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
13159 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
13160 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013162 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13163 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013165 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013167status : integer
13168 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13169 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13170 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013172url : string
13173 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13174 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13175 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13176 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13177 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13178 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13179 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013181 ACL derivatives :
13182 url : exact string match
13183 url_beg : prefix match
13184 url_dir : subdir match
13185 url_dom : domain match
13186 url_end : suffix match
13187 url_len : length match
13188 url_reg : regex match
13189 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013191url_ip : ip
13192 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13193 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13194 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13195 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13196 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13197 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13198 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013200url_port : integer
13201 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13202 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13203 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13204 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013205
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013206urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13207url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13209 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013210 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13211 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13212 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13213 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013214 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13215 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013216 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13217 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013219 ACL derivatives :
13220 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13221 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13222 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13223 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13224 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13225 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13226 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13227 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013228
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013230 Example :
13231 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13232 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13233 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13234 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013235
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013236urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013237 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13238 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13239 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013240
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132427.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013243---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013245Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13246every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013247order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013249ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13250---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013251FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013252HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013253HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13254HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013255HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13256HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13257HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13258HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13259LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013260METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13261METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13262METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13263METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13264METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13265METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013266RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013267REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013268TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013269WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13270---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013271
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132738. Logging
13274----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013275
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013276One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
13277provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
13278very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
13279provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
13280state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013281to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013282headers.
13283
13284In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
13285about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
13286send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
13287
13288 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
13289 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
13290 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
13291 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
13292 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060013293 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
13294 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013295
13296The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
13297allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
13298as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
13299while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
13300real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
13301delay.
13302
13303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133048.1. Log levels
13305---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013306
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013307TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013308source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013309HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13310in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13311track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13312syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13313about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013314
13315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133168.2. Log formats
13317----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013318
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013319HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013320and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13321slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13322options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013323
13324 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13325 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13326 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13327 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13328 extents.
13329
13330 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13331 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13332 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13333 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13334 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13335
13336 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13337 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13338 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13339 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13340 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13341
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013342 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13343 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13344 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13345 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13346
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013347 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13348
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013349Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13350specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13351field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13352servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13353always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13354identifier.
13355
13356Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13357 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13358 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13359 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13360 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13361
13362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133638.2.1. Default log format
13364-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013365
13366This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13367as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13368format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13369
13370 Example :
13371 listen www
13372 mode http
13373 log global
13374 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13375
13376 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13377 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13378 (www/HTTP)
13379
13380 Field Format Extract from the example above
13381 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13382 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13383 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13384 4 'to' to
13385 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13386 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13387
13388Detailed fields description :
13389 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13390 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13391 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13392 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13393 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13394 and processed the connection.
13395 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13396
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013397In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13398"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13399connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13400
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013401It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13402will eventually disappear.
13403
13404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134058.2.2. TCP log format
13406---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013407
13408The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13409is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13410information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13411counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13412emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13413environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13414the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13415sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013416specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13417not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13418fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13419marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013420
13421 Example :
13422 frontend fnt
13423 mode tcp
13424 option tcplog
13425 log global
13426 default_backend bck
13427
13428 backend bck
13429 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13430
13431 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13432 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13433 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13434
13435 Field Format Extract from the example above
13436 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13437 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13438 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13439 4 frontend_name fnt
13440 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13441 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13442 7 bytes_read* 212
13443 8 termination_state --
13444 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13445 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13446
13447Detailed fields description :
13448 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013449 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13450 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13451 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13452 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13453 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013454
13455 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013456 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13457 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13458 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013459
13460 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13461 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13462 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13463 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13464
13465 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13466 and processed the connection.
13467
13468 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13469 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13470 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13471 applications.
13472
13473 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13474 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13475 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13476 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13477 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13478
13479 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13480 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13481 See "Timers" below for more details.
13482
13483 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13484 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13485 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13486 "Timers" below for more details.
13487
13488 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013489 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013490 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13491 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13492 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13493 details.
13494
13495 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13496 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13497 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13498 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13499 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13500
13501 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13502 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13503 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13504 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13505 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13506 for more details.
13507
13508 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013509 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013510 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13511 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13512 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013513 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013514
13515 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13516 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13517 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13518 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13519 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13520 caused by a denial of service attack.
13521
13522 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13523 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13524 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13525 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13526 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13527 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13528 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13529 denial of service attack.
13530
13531 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13532 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13533 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13534 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13535 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13536 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13537 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13538 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13539 be processed than on other servers.
13540
13541 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13542 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13543 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13544 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13545 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13546 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13547 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13548 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13549 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13550 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13551 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13552 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13553 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13554
13555 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13556 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13557 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13558 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13559 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13560 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13561 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13562 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13563
13564 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13565 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13566 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13567 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13568 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13569 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13570 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13571 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13572 occurs.
13573
13574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135758.2.3. HTTP log format
13576----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013577
13578The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13579is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13580the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13581are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13582emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13583generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13584"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13585which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013586frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13587is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013588
13589Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13590slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13591with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13592
13593 Example :
13594 frontend http-in
13595 mode http
13596 option httplog
13597 log global
13598 default_backend bck
13599
13600 backend static
13601 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13602
13603 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13604 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13605 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013606 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013607
13608 Field Format Extract from the example above
13609 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13610 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13611 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13612 4 frontend_name http-in
13613 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13614 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13615 7 status_code 200
13616 8 bytes_read* 2750
13617 9 captured_request_cookie -
13618 10 captured_response_cookie -
13619 11 termination_state ----
13620 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13621 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13622 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13623 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13624 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013625
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013626
13627Detailed fields description :
13628 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013629 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13630 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13631 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13632 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13633 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013634
13635 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013636 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13637 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13638 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013639
13640 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13641 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13642 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13643 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13644 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13645
13646 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13647 and processed the connection.
13648
13649 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13650 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13651 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13652
13653 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13654 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13655 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13656 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13657 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13658 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13659
13660 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13661 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13662 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13663 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13664 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13665 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13666
13667 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13668 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13669 See "Timers" below for more details.
13670
13671 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13672 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13673 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13674 below for more details.
13675
13676 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13677 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13678 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13679 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13680 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13681 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13682 for more details.
13683
13684 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013685 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013686 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13687 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13688 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13689 details.
13690
13691 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13692 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13693 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13694
13695 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13696 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13697 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13698 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13699 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13700 overflowing.
13701
13702 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13703 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13704 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13705 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13706 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13707 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13708 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13709 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13710
13711 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13712 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13713 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13714 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13715 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13716 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13717 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13718 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13719
13720 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13721 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13722 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13723 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13724 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13725 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13726 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13727
13728 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013729 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013730 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13731 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13732 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013733 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013734 system.
13735
13736 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13737 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13738 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13739 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13740 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13741 caused by a denial of service attack.
13742
13743 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13744 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13745 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13746 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13747 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13748 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13749 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13750 denial of service attack.
13751
13752 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13753 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13754 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13755 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13756 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13757 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13758 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13759 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13760 processed than on other servers.
13761
13762 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13763 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13764 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13765 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13766 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13767 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13768 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13769 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13770 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13771 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13772 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13773 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13774 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13775
13776 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13777 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13778 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13779 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13780 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13781 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13782 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13783 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13784
13785 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13786 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13787 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13788 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13789 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13790 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13791 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13792 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13793 occurs.
13794
13795 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13796 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13797 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13798 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13799 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13800 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13801 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13802 cookies" below for more details.
13803
13804 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13805 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13806 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13807 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13808 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13809 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13810 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13811 and cookies" below for more details.
13812
13813 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13814 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13815 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13816 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13817 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13818 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13819 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13820 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13821
13822
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200138238.2.4. Custom log format
13824------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013825
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013826The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013827mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013828
13829HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13830Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13831separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13832prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13833
13834Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13835variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13836string formats ("Q").
13837
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013838If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013839as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013840less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13841the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13842
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013843Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013844In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013845in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013846
13847Flags are :
13848 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013849 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013850
13851 Example:
13852
13853 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13854 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13855
13856At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13857
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013858 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13859 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013860
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013861the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013862
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013863 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013864 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013865 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013866
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013867and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13868
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013869 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013870 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13871
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013872Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13873
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013874 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013875 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013876 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13877 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13878 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013879 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13880 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13881 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013882 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013883 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13884 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13885 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13886 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013887 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013888 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013889 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013890 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013891 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013892 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13893 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013894 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013895 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13896 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013897 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013898 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13899 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013900 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13901 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13902 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013903 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013904 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13905 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013906 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013907 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13908 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13909 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013910 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013911 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013912 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13913 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13914 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13915 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013916 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013917 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013918 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013919 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013920 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013921 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013922 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13923 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13924 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013925 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013926 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13927 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013928 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013929 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013930 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013931 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013932
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013933 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013934
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013935
139368.2.5. Error log format
13937-----------------------
13938
13939When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13940protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13941By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13942"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13943will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13944logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13945
13946The format looks like this :
13947
13948 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13949 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13950 Connection error during SSL handshake
13951
13952 Field Format Extract from the example above
13953 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13954 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13955 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13956 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13957 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13958
13959These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13960failures.
13961
13962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139638.3. Advanced logging options
13964-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013965
13966Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13967just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13968options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13969for more information about their usage.
13970
13971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139728.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13973------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013974
13975It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13976haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13977commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13978monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13979ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13980
13981 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13982 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13983 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13984 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13985
13986 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13987 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13988 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013989 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013990 such as other load-balancers.
13991
13992 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13993 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13994 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13995
13996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13998----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013999
14000The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14001what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14002or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14003"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14004just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14005log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14006after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14007is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14008with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14009with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14010
14011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140128.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14013------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014014
14015Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14016for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14017"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14018retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14019raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14020a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14021file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14022you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14023"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14024
14025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140268.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14027--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014028
14029Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14030multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14031them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14032"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14033logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14034error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14035and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14036too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14037useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14038alternative.
14039
14040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140418.4. Timing events
14042------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014043
14044Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14045reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14046the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14047frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14048mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14049
14050 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14051 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14052 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14053 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14054 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14055
14056 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14057 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14058 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14059 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14060 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14061
14062 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14063 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14064 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14065 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14066 connection never established.
14067
14068 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14069 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14070 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14071 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14072 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14073 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14074 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14075 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14076 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14077 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14078 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14079
14080 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14081 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14082 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14083 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014084 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014085
14086 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14087
14088 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14089 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14090 negative.
14091
14092These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14093protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14094that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014095due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014096close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14097session has been aborted on timeout.
14098
14099Most common cases :
14100
14101 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14102 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14103 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14104 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14105 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14106 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14107 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14108 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14109 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014110 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
14111 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14112 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014113
14114 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14115 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14116 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14117 of ms on remote networks.
14118
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014119 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14120 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14121 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014122
14123 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14124 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14125 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14126 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14127 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14128 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14129 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14130 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14131 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14132 to the server until another one is released.
14133
14134Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14135
14136 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14137 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14138 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14139
14140 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14141 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14142 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14143
14144 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14145 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14146 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14147 flags.
14148
14149 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14150 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14151 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14152 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14153 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14154 the client connection was maintained open.
14155
14156 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014157 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014158 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14159 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14160
14161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141628.5. Session state at disconnection
14163-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014164
14165TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14166"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
141672-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14168each of which has a special meaning :
14169
14170 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14171 session to terminate :
14172
14173 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14174
14175 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14176 server explicitly refused it.
14177
14178 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14179 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14180 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14181 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014182 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14183
14184 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14185 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014186
14187 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14188 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14189 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14190 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14191 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14192
14193 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14194 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14195 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14196 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14197 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14198
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014199 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14200 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14201
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014202 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14203 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14204 backup connections when going up.
14205
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014206 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14207
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014208 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14209 send or receive data.
14210
14211 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14212 send or receive data.
14213
14214 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14215 with nothing left in the buffers.
14216
14217 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14218
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014219 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014220 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14221
14222 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14223 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14224 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14225 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14226 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14227
14228 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14229 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14230
14231 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14232 server (HTTP only).
14233
14234 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14235
14236 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14237 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14238 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14239
14240 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14241 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14242 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14243
14244 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14245
14246 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14247 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14248
14249 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14250 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14251 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14252
14253 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14254 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014255 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14256 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014257
14258 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14259 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14260 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14261 another server.
14262
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014263 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014264 server.
14265
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014266 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
14267 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
14268 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
14269 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14270
14271 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
14272 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
14273 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
14274 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14275
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020014276 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
14277 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
14278 "use-server" rule).
14279
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014280 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14281
14282 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
14283 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
14284
14285 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
14286
14287 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
14288 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
14289 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
14290
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014291 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
14292 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014293 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014294 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
14295 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
14296
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014297 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
14298
14299 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
14300 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
14301
14302 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
14303
14304 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14305
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014306The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14307was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014308helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14309starvation, attacks, etc...
14310
14311The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14312alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14313easier finding and understanding.
14314
14315 Flags Reason
14316
14317 -- Normal termination.
14318
14319 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14320 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14321 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14322 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14323
14324 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14325 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14326 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14327 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14328 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14329 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014330
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014331 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14332 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014333 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014334
14335 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14336 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14337 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14338
14339 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14340 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14341 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14342 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14343 the server takes too long to respond.
14344
14345 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14346 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14347 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14348 long a time to respond.
14349
14350 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14351 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14352 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14353 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014354 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14355 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014356
14357 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14358 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14359 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14360 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14361 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014362 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014363 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14364 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14365 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14366 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14367 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14368 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14369 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14370 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14371 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14372 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14373 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14374 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014375
14376 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14377 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014378 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14379 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14380 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14381 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014382
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014383 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14384 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014386 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014387 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14388 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14389 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14390 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14391 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14392
14393 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14394 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14395 503 or 504 here.
14396
14397 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14398 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14399 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14400 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14401 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14402
14403 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14404 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014405 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014406 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14407 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14408
14409 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14410 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14411 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14412 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14413 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14414 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14415 between haproxy and the server.
14416
14417 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14418 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14419 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14420 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14421 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14422 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14423 solution is to fix the application.
14424
14425 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14426 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14427 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14428 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14429 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14430 external attacks.
14431
14432 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14433 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014434 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014435 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14436 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14437
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014438 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14439 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14440 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014441 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14442 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014443
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014444 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14445 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14446 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14447 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014448 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14449 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14450 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14451 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14452 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014453
14454 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14455 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14456 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14457 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14458
14459 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14460 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14461 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14462 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14463
14464 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14465 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14466 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14467 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14468
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014469The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14470persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14471important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14472re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14473
14474 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14475
14476 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14477 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14478 set on a GET request.
14479
14480 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14481 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014482 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014483 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14484
14485 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14486 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14487 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14488
14489 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14490 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14491 already got a cookie.
14492
14493 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14494 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14495 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14496 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14497 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14498
14499 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14500 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14501 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14502
14503 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14504 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14505 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14506
14507 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14508 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14509
14510 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14511 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14512 then advertised in the response.
14513
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145158.6. Non-printable characters
14516-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014517
14518In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14519consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14520converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14521prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14522being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14523escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14524is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14525'}' when logging headers.
14526
14527Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14528issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14529containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14530
14531Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14532the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14533performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14534
14535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145368.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14537---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014538
14539Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14540achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014541section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014542cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14543the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14544the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014545locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014546not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14547user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14548a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14549wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14550
14551 Examples :
14552 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14553 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14554
14555 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14556 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14557
14558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145598.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14560---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014561
14562Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14563proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14564the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14565server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14566
14567Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14568response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014569section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014570
14571It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014572time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14573appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014574are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14575and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14576follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14577request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14578in the logs.
14579
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014580As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14581frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14582an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14583
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014584 Example :
14585 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14586 listen proxy-out
14587 mode http
14588 option httplog
14589 option logasap
14590 log global
14591 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14592
14593 # log the name of the virtual server
14594 capture request header Host len 20
14595
14596 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14597 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14598
14599 # log the beginning of the referrer
14600 capture request header Referer len 20
14601
14602 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14603 capture response header Server len 20
14604
14605 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14606 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14607
14608 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14609 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14610
14611 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14612 capture response header Via len 20
14613
14614 # log the URL location during a redirection
14615 capture response header Location len 20
14616
14617 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14618 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14619 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14620 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14621 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14622
14623 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14624 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14625 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14626 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014627 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014628
14629 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14630 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14631 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14632 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14633 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014634 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014635
14636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146378.9. Examples of logs
14638---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014639
14640These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14641them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14642reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14643
14644 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14645 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14646 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14647
14648 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14649 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14650
14651 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14652 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14653 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14654
14655 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14656 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14657
14658 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14659 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14660 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14661
14662 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014663 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014664 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14665 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14666
14667 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14668 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14669 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14670
14671 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14672 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014673 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014674 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14675 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14676 to return the 502 and not the server.
14677
14678 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014679 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014680
14681 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14682 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14683 Nothing was sent to any server.
14684
14685 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14686 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14687
14688 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14689 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14690 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14691 send a 408 return code to the client.
14692
14693 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14694 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14695
14696 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14697 5 seconds ("c----").
14698
14699 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14700 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014701 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014702
14703 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014704 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014705 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14706 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14707 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14708 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14709 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014710
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147129. Statistics and monitoring
14713----------------------------
14714
14715It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14716mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14717CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14718Unix socket.
14719
14720
147219.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014722---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014723
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014724The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014725page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14726begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14727represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14728use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14729('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14730(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14731text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14732do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14733use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014734
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014735In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14736that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14737S (Servers).
14738
14739 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14740 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14741 any name for server/listener)
14742 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14743 number queued without a server assigned.
14744 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14745 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14746 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14747 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14748 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14749 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14750 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14751 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14752 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14753 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14754 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14755 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14756 "option checkcache".
14757 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14758 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14759 - read error from the client
14760 - client timeout
14761 - client closed connection
14762 - various bad requests from the client.
14763 - request was tarpitted.
14764 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14765 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14766 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14767 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14768 active servers).
14769 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14770 Some other errors are:
14771 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14772 - failure applying filters to the response.
14773 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14774 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14775 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14776 switched away from.
14777 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020014778 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
14779 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
14780 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014781 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14782 the server is up.)
14783 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14784 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14785 counters for each server.
14786 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14787 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14788 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14789 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14790 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14791 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14792 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14793 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14794 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14795 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14796 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14797 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14798 of times that server was selected.
14799 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14800 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14801 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14802 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14803 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14804 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014805 UNK -> unknown
14806 INI -> initializing
14807 SOCKERR -> socket error
14808 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014809 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014810 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14811 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14812 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14813 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14814 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14815 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14816 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14817 disable-on-404
14818 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14819 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14820 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014821 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14822 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14823 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14824 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14825 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14826 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14827 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14828 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14829 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14830 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14831 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14832 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14833 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14834 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14835 (inc. in eresp)
14836 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14837 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14838 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14839 (CPU/BW limit)
14840 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14841 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14842 server/backend
14843 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14844 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14845 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14846 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14847 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14848 (0 for TCP)
14849 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14850 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014851
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148539.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014854-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014855
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014856The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14857necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14858A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14859issuing commands by hand :
14860
14861 global
14862 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14863 stats timeout 2m
14864
14865It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14866the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14867never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14868situations :
14869
14870 global
14871 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14872 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14873 stats timeout 2m
14874
14875To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14876swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14877to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14878syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14879
14880 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14881 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14882
14883The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14884script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14885for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14886
14887The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14888that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14889editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14890(eg: watch a counter).
14891
14892The socket supports two operation modes :
14893 - interactive
14894 - non-interactive
14895
14896The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14897this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14898sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14899mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14900commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14901example :
14902
14903 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14904
14905The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14906entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14907for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14908sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14909"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14910after processing the last command of the same line.
14911
14912For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14913"prompt" command :
14914
14915 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14916 prompt
14917 > show info
14918 ...
14919 >
14920
14921Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14922delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14923that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14924parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014925
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014926It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14927on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14928own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014929
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014930The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14931If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14932all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14933it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14934
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014935add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014936 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14937 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14938 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14939 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014940
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014941add map <map> <key> <value>
14942 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14943 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014944 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14945 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14946 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014947
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014948clear counters
14949 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14950 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14951 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14952 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14953 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14954
14955clear counters all
14956 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14957 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14958 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14959
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014960clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014961 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14962 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14963 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014964
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014965clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014966 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14967 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14968 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014969
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014970clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14971 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14972
14973 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14974 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14975 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14976 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14977 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14978 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14979
14980 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14981
14982 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14983 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14984 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14985 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14986 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14987 the ACLs :
14988
14989 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14990 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14991 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14992 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14993 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14994 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14995
14996 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014997 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14998 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014999
15000 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015001 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015002 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015003 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15004 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15005 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15006 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015007
15008 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15009
15010 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015011 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015012 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15013 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015014 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15015 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15016 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015017
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015018del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
15019 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015020 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
15021 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15022 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
15023 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015024
15025del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015026 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015027 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
15028 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15029 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
15030 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015031
15032disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015033 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
15034
15035 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
15036 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
15037 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
15038 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
15039 re-enabled using enable agent.
15040
15041 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
15042 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
15043 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
15044 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
15045 otherwise unchanged.
15046
15047 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
15048 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
15049 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
15050
15051 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15052 level "admin".
15053
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015054disable frontend <frontend>
15055 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
15056 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
15057 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
15058 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
15059 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
15060 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
15061 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
15062 on the stats page.
15063
15064 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15065 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15066
15067 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15068 level "admin".
15069
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015070disable health <backend>/<server>
15071 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
15072 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
15073 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
15074 agent check forces it down.
15075
15076 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15077 level "admin".
15078
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015079disable server <backend>/<server>
15080 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
15081 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
15082 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
15083 during the maintenance.
15084
15085 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
15086 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
15087
15088 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015089 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015090
15091 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15092 level "admin".
15093
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015094enable agent <backend>/<server>
15095 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
15096
15097 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
15098 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
15099
15100 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15101 level "admin".
15102
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015103enable frontend <frontend>
15104 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
15105 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
15106 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
15107 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
15108 which was disabled.
15109
15110 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15111 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15112
15113 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15114 level "admin".
15115
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015116enable health <backend>/<server>
15117 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
15118 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
15119
15120 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15121 level "admin".
15122
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015123enable server <backend>/<server>
15124 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
15125 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
15126
15127 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015128 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015129
15130 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15131 level "admin".
15132
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015133get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015134get acl <acl> <value>
15135 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
15136 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
15137 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
15138 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
15139 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015140
15141 The first two words are:
15142
15143 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
15144 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
15145 "dom", "end" or "reg".
15146
15147 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
15148
15149 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
15150
15151 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
15152
15153 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
15154 interpretation of the case.
15155
15156 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
15157 useful with regular expressions.
15158
15159 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
15160 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
15161
15162 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
15163 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
15164 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
15165
15166 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
15167
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015168get weight <backend>/<server>
15169 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
15170 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
15171 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
15172 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
15173 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015174 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015175
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015176help
15177 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
15178 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015179
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015180prompt
15181 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
15182 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
15183 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
15184 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
15185 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
15186 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
15187 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
15188 command.
15189
15190quit
15191 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015192
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015193set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015194 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
15195 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
15196 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015197
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015198set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020015199 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
15200 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
15201 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
15202 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
15203 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015204 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
15205 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15206
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020015207set maxconn global <maxconn>
15208 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
15209 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
15210 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
15211 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
15212 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
15213 setting.
15214
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020015215set rate-limit connections global <value>
15216 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
15217 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15218 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15219 is passed in number of connections per second.
15220
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015221set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
15222 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
15223 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010015224 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
15225 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015226
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020015227set rate-limit sessions global <value>
15228 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
15229 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15230 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15231 is passed in number of sessions per second.
15232
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020015233set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
15234 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
15235 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15236 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15237 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
15238 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
15239
Baptiste Assmann3d8f8312015-04-13 22:54:33 +020015240set server <backend>/<server> addr <ip4 or ip6 address>
15241 Replace the current IP address of a server by the one provided.
15242
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020015243set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
15244 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15245 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
15246 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15247
15248set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
15249 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15250 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
15251 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15252
15253set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
15254 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
15255 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
15256 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
15257 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
15258 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
15259 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
15260 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
15261 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
15262
15263set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
15264 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
15265 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
15266
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015267set ssl ocsp-response <response>
15268 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
15269 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
15270 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
15271 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
15272
15273 Example:
15274 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
15275 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
15276 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
15277 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
15278
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015279set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
15280 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
15281 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
15282 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
15283 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
15284 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
15285
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015286set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015287 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
15288 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
15289 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
15290 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015291 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
15292 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015293
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015294set timeout cli <delay>
15295 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
15296 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
15297 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
15298
15299set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
15300 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
15301 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090015302 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
15303 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
15304 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
15305 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
15306 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
15307 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
15308 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
15309 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
15310 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
15311 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
15312 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
15313 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
15314 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015315
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015316show errors [<iid>]
15317 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
15318 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015319 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
15320 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
15321 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015322
15323 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
15324 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
15325 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
15326 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
15327 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
15328 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
15329 are reported too.
15330
15331 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
15332 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
15333 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
15334 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
15335 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
15336 code.
15337
15338 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
15339 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
15340 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
15341 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
15342 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
15343 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
15344 line.
15345
15346 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015347 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15348 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015349 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
15350 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
15351
15352 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
15353 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
15354 00038 Location: blah\r\n
15355 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
15356 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
15357 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
15358 00204+ minal\r\n
15359 00211 \r\n
15360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015361 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015362 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
15363 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
15364 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
15365 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
15366 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
15367 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015368
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015369show info
15370 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
15371
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015372show map [<map>]
15373 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015374 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15375 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15376 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15377 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15378 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15379 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015380
15381show acl [<acl>]
15382 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015383 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15384 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15385 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15386 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15387 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015388
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015389show pools
15390 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15391 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15392 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15393 the pools.
15394
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015395show sess
15396 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015397 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
15398 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15399
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010015400show sess <id>
15401 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
15402 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15403 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
15404 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
15405 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020015406 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
15407 returned in src/dumpstats.c
15408
15409 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
15410 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015411
15412show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
15413 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
15414 possible to dump only selected items :
15415 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15416 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15417 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15418 for example:
15419 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15420 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15421 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15422
15423 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015424 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15425 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015426 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15427 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15428 Nbproc: 1
15429 Process_num: 1
15430 (...)
15431
15432 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15433 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15434 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15435 (...)
15436 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15437
15438 $
15439
15440 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15441 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15442 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15443 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015444 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015445
Baptiste Assmann3863f972015-05-17 00:33:24 +020015446show stat resolvers <resolvers section id>
15447 Dump statistics for the given resolvers section.
15448 For each name server, the following counters are reported:
15449 sent: number of DNS requests sent to this server
15450 valid: number of DNS valid responses received from this server
15451 update: number of DNS responses used to update the server's IP address
15452 cname: number of CNAME responses
15453 cname_error: CNAME errors encountered with this server
15454 any_err: number of empty response (IE: server does not support ANY type)
15455 nx: non existent domain response received from this server
15456 timeout: how many time this server did not answer in time
15457 refused: number of requests refused by this server
15458 other: any other DNS errors
15459 invalid: invalid DNS response (from a protocol point of view)
15460 too_big: too big response
15461 outdated: number of response arrived too late (after an other name server)
15462
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015463show table
15464 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15465 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15466 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15467 entries currently in use.
15468
15469 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015470 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015471 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15472 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015473
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015474show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015475 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15476 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15477 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015478 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15479
15480 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15481 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15482 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15483 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15484 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15485
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015486 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15487 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15488 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15489 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15490 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15491 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15492
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015493
15494 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015495 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15496 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015497
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015498 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015499 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015500 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015501 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15502 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15503 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15504 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015505
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015506 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015507 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015508 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15509 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015510
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015511 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15512 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015513 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015514 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15515 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015516
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015517 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15518 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015519 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015520 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15521 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15522
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015523 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15524 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15525 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15526 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15527 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15528
15529 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15530 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15531 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015532 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15533 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015534 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15535 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015536
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015537show tls-keys
15538 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15539 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15540 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15541
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015542shutdown frontend <frontend>
15543 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15544 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15545 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15546 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15547 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15548 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15549 once it is terminated.
15550
15551 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15552 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15553
15554 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15555 level "admin".
15556
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015557shutdown session <id>
15558 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15559 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15560 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15561 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15562 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15563 flag in the logs.
15564
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015565shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015566 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15567 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15568 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15569 'K' flag in the logs.
15570
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015571/*
15572 * Local variables:
15573 * fill-column: 79
15574 * End:
15575 */